1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4 *
5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6 * Copyright 2006-2007 Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7 * Copyright 2007-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2026 Intel Corporation
11 */
12
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
23 #include <net/codel.h>
24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
25 #include <linux/unaligned.h>
26
27 /**
28 * DOC: Introduction
29 *
30 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
31 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
32 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
33 * drivers.
34 */
35
36 /**
37 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
38 *
39 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
40 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
41 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
42 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
43 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
44 * tasklet function.
45 *
46 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
47 * use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
48 */
49
50 /**
51 * DOC: Warning
52 *
53 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
54 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
55 */
56
57 /**
58 * DOC: Frame format
59 *
60 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
61 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
62 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
63 * hardware.
64 *
65 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
66 *
67 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
68 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
69 *
70 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
71 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
72 */
73
74 /**
75 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
76 *
77 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
78 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
79 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
80 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
81 *
82 * mac80211 will flush the workqueue upon interface removal and during
83 * suspend.
84 *
85 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
86 *
87 */
88
89 /**
90 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
91 *
92 * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
93 * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
94 * different stations/interfaces.
95 *
96 * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
97 * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
98 * handler.
99 *
100 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
101 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
102 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
103 *
104 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
105 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
106 *
107 * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
108 * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
109 * driver op.
110 * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
111 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
112 * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
113 *
114 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
115 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
116 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
117 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
118 * ieee80211_return_txq().
119 *
120 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
121 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
122 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
123 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
124 * .release_buffered_frames().
125 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
126 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
127 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
128 */
129
130 /**
131 * DOC: HW timestamping
132 *
133 * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
134 * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
135 *
136 * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
137 * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
138 * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
139 * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
140 *
141 * Similarly, to report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
142 * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
143 * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
144 * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
145 */
146 struct device;
147
148 /**
149 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
150 *
151 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
152 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
153 */
154 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
155 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES = 16,
156 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP = BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
157 };
158
159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 0xff
160
161 /**
162 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
163 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
164 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
165 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
166 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
167 */
168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
169 IEEE80211_AC_VO = 0,
170 IEEE80211_AC_VI = 1,
171 IEEE80211_AC_BE = 2,
172 IEEE80211_AC_BK = 3,
173 };
174
175 /**
176 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
177 *
178 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
179 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
180 *
181 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
182 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
183 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
184 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
185 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
186 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
187 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
188 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
189 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
190 */
191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
192 u16 txop;
193 u16 cw_min;
194 u16 cw_max;
195 u8 aifs;
196 bool acm;
197 bool uapsd;
198 bool mu_edca;
199 struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
200 };
201
202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
203 unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
204 unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
205 unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
206 unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
207 };
208
209 /**
210 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
211 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
212 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
213 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
214 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
215 * this is used only with channel switching with CSA
216 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_DEF: The min chandef changed
217 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP: The AP channel definition changed, so (wider
218 * bandwidth) OFDMA settings need to be changed
219 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING: The punctured channel(s) bitmap
220 * was changed.
221 */
222 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
223 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH = BIT(0),
224 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS = BIT(1),
225 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR = BIT(2),
226 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(3),
227 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_DEF = BIT(4),
228 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP = BIT(5),
229 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING = BIT(6),
230 };
231
232 /**
233 * struct ieee80211_chan_req - A channel "request"
234 * @oper: channel definition to use for operation
235 * @ap: the channel definition of the AP, if any
236 * (otherwise the chan member is %NULL)
237 */
238 struct ieee80211_chan_req {
239 struct cfg80211_chan_def oper;
240 struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
241 };
242
243 /**
244 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
245 *
246 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
247 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
248 *
249 * @def: the channel definition
250 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
251 * @ap: the channel definition the AP actually is operating as,
252 * for use with (wider bandwidth) OFDMA
253 * @radio_idx: index of the wiphy radio used used for this channel
254 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
255 * active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
256 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
257 * after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
258 * this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
259 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
260 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
261 * sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
262 */
263 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
264 struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
265 struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
266 struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
267
268 int radio_idx;
269 u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
270
271 bool radar_enabled;
272
273 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
274 };
275
276 /**
277 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
278 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
279 * exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
280 * needs to be switched from one to the other.
281 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
282 * to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
283 * will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
284 * from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
285 * implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
286 * hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
287 * will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
288 * for changes/removal.)
289 */
290 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
291 CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
292 CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
293 };
294
295 /**
296 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
297 *
298 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
299 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another. The
300 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
301 * done.
302 *
303 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
304 * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
305 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
306 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
307 */
308 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
309 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
310 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
311 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
312 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
313 };
314
315 /**
316 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
317 *
318 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
319 * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
320 *
321 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
322 * also implies a change in the AID.
323 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
324 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
325 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
326 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
327 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
328 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
329 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
330 * reason (IBSS and managed mode)
331 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
332 * new beacon (beaconing modes)
333 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
334 * enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
335 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
336 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
337 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
338 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
339 * that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
340 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
341 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
342 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
343 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
344 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
345 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
346 * changed
347 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
348 * currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
349 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
350 * note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
351 * context had been assigned.
352 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
353 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
354 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
355 * keep alive) changed.
356 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
357 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
358 * functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
359 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
360 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
361 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
362 * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
363 * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
364 * status changed.
365 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS: MLD valid links status changed.
366 * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM: negotiated TID to link mapping was changed
367 * @BSS_CHANGED_TPE: transmit power envelope changed
368 */
369 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
370 BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC = 1<<0,
371 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT = 1<<1,
372 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE = 1<<2,
373 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT = 1<<3,
374 BSS_CHANGED_HT = 1<<4,
375 BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES = 1<<5,
376 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT = 1<<6,
377 BSS_CHANGED_BSSID = 1<<7,
378 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON = 1<<8,
379 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED = 1<<9,
380 BSS_CHANGED_CQM = 1<<10,
381 BSS_CHANGED_IBSS = 1<<11,
382 BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER = 1<<12,
383 BSS_CHANGED_QOS = 1<<13,
384 BSS_CHANGED_IDLE = 1<<14,
385 BSS_CHANGED_SSID = 1<<15,
386 BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP = 1<<16,
387 BSS_CHANGED_PS = 1<<17,
388 BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER = 1<<18,
389 BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS = 1<<19,
390 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO = 1<<20,
391 BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH = 1<<21,
392 BSS_CHANGED_OCB = 1<<22,
393 BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS = 1<<23,
394 BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE = 1<<24,
395 BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE = 1<<25,
396 BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER = 1<<26,
397 BSS_CHANGED_TWT = 1<<27,
398 BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD = 1<<28,
399 BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR = 1<<29,
400 BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY = 1<<30,
401 BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = BIT_ULL(31),
402 BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS = BIT_ULL(33),
403 BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM = BIT_ULL(34),
404 BSS_CHANGED_TPE = BIT_ULL(35),
405
406 /* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
407 };
408
409 /*
410 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
411 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
412 * filtering will be disabled.
413 */
414 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
415
416 /**
417 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
418 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
419 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
420 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
421 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
422 * they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
423 * once each time the timeout triggers.
424 */
425 enum ieee80211_event_type {
426 RSSI_EVENT,
427 MLME_EVENT,
428 BAR_RX_EVENT,
429 BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
430 };
431
432 /**
433 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
434 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
435 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
436 */
437 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
438 RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
439 RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
440 };
441
442 /**
443 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
444 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
445 */
446 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
447 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
448 };
449
450 /**
451 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
452 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
453 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
454 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
455 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
456 */
457 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
458 AUTH_EVENT,
459 ASSOC_EVENT,
460 DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
461 DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
462 };
463
464 /**
465 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
466 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
467 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
468 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
469 */
470 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
471 MLME_SUCCESS,
472 MLME_DENIED,
473 MLME_TIMEOUT,
474 };
475
476 /**
477 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
478 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
479 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
480 * @reason: the reason code if applicable
481 */
482 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
483 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
484 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
485 u16 reason;
486 };
487
488 /**
489 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
490 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
491 * @tid: the tid
492 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
493 */
494 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
495 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
496 u16 tid;
497 u16 ssn;
498 };
499
500 /**
501 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
502 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
503 * @u.rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
504 * @u.mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
505 * @u.ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
506 * @u:union holding the fields above
507 */
508 struct ieee80211_event {
509 enum ieee80211_event_type type;
510 union {
511 struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
512 struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
513 struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
514 } u;
515 };
516
517 /**
518 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
519 *
520 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
521 *
522 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
523 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
524 */
525 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
526 u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
527 u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
528 };
529
530 /**
531 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
532 *
533 * @lci: LCI subelement content
534 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
535 * @lci_len: LCI data length
536 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
537 */
538 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
539 const u8 *lci;
540 const u8 *civicloc;
541 size_t lci_len;
542 size_t civicloc_len;
543 };
544
545 /**
546 * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
547 * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
548 *
549 * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
550 * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
551 */
552 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
553 u32 min_interval;
554 u32 max_interval;
555 };
556
557 #define IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ 5
558 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp {
559 bool valid;
560 s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
561 u8 count;
562 };
563
564 #define IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ 16
565 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd {
566 bool valid;
567 s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
568 u8 count, n;
569 };
570
571 /**
572 * struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe - parsed transmit power envelope information
573 * @max_local: maximum local EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80, 160, 320 MHz each
574 * (indexed by TX power category)
575 * @max_reg_client: maximum regulatory client EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80,
576 * 160, 320 MHz each
577 * (indexed by TX power category)
578 * @psd_local: maximum local power spectral density, one value for each 20 MHz
579 * subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
580 * (indexed by TX power category)
581 * @psd_reg_client: maximum regulatory power spectral density, one value for
582 * each 20 MHz subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
583 * (indexed by TX power category)
584 */
585 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe {
586 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp max_local[2], max_reg_client[2];
587 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd psd_local[2], psd_reg_client[2];
588 };
589
590 /**
591 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
592 *
593 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
594 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
595 *
596 * @vif: reference to owning VIF
597 * @bss: the cfg80211 bss descriptor. Valid only for a station, and only
598 * when associated. Note: This contains information which is not
599 * necessarily authenticated. For example, information coming from probe
600 * responses.
601 * @addr: (link) address used locally
602 * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
603 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
604 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
605 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
606 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
607 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
608 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
609 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
610 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
611 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
612 * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
613 * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
614 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
615 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
616 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
617 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
618 * valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
619 * with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
620 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
621 * as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
622 * HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
623 * only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
624 * association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
625 * %BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
626 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
627 * the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
628 * (see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
629 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
630 * is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
631 * IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
632 * by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
633 * guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
634 * Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
635 * know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
636 * @beacon_int: beacon interval
637 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
638 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
639 * index into the rate table configured by the driver in
640 * the current band.
641 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
642 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
643 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
644 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
645 * @chanreq: Channel request for this BSS -- the hardware might be
646 * configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
647 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
648 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
649 * This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
650 * Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
651 * be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
652 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
653 * implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
654 * cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
655 * relation to the newly configured threshold.
656 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
657 * implies disabled. This is an alternative mechanism to the single
658 * threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
659 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
660 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
661 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
662 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
663 * @txpower: TX power in dBm. INT_MIN means not configured.
664 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
665 * Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
666 * TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
667 * NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
668 * userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
669 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
670 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
671 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
672 * to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
673 * if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
674 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
675 * transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
676 * In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
677 * a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
678 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
679 * protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
680 * station.
681 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
682 * responder functionality.
683 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
684 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
685 * @tx_bss_conf: Pointer to the BSS configuration of transmitting interface
686 * if MBSSID is enabled. This pointer is RCU-protected due to CSA finish
687 * and BSS color change flows accessing it.
688 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
689 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
690 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
691 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
692 * nontransmitted BSSIDs
693 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
694 * in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
695 * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
696 * connected to (STA)
697 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
698 * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
699 * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
700 * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
701 * interval.
702 * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
703 * to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
704 * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
705 * @tpe: transmit power envelope information
706 * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
707 * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
708 * @epcs_support: does this BSS support EPCS
709 * @uhr_support: does this BSS support UHR
710 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on.
711 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
712 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
713 * when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
714 * path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
715 * be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
716 * processed after it switches back to %NULL.
717 * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing.
718 * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
719 * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
720 * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
721 * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
722 * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
723 * beamformer
724 * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
725 * beamformee
726 * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
727 * beamformer
728 * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
729 * beamformee
730 * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
731 * beamformer
732 * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
733 * beamformee
734 * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
735 * beamformer
736 * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
737 * (non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
738 * bandwidth
739 * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
740 * beamformer
741 * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
742 * beamformee
743 * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
744 * beamformer
745 * @eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo: in AP-mode, does this BSS support the
746 * reception of an EHT TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
747 * bandwidth
748 * @eht_disable_mcs15: disable EHT-MCS 15 reception capability.
749 * @bss_param_ch_cnt: in BSS-mode, the BSS params change count. This
750 * information is the latest known value. It can come from this link's
751 * beacon or from a beacon sent by another link.
752 * @bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id: in BSS-mode, the link_id to which the beacon
753 * that updated &bss_param_ch_cnt belongs. E.g. if link 1 doesn't hear
754 * its beacons, and link 2 sent a beacon with an RNR element that updated
755 * link 1's BSS params change count, then, link 1's
756 * bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id will be 2. That means that link 1 knows that
757 * link 2 was the link that updated its bss_param_ch_cnt value.
758 * In case link 1 hears its beacon again, bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id will
759 * be updated to 1, even if bss_param_ch_cnt didn't change. This allows
760 * the link to know that it heard the latest value from its own beacon
761 * (as opposed to hearing its value from another link's beacon).
762 * @s1g_long_beacon_period: number of beacon intervals between each long
763 * beacon transmission.
764 */
765 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
766 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
767 struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
768
769 const u8 *bssid;
770 unsigned int link_id;
771 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
772 u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
773 bool uora_exists;
774 u8 uora_ocw_range;
775 u16 frame_time_rts_th;
776 bool he_support;
777 bool twt_requester;
778 bool twt_responder;
779 bool twt_protected;
780 bool twt_broadcast;
781 /* erp related data */
782 bool use_cts_prot;
783 bool use_short_preamble;
784 bool use_short_slot;
785 bool enable_beacon;
786 u8 dtim_period;
787 u16 beacon_int;
788 u16 assoc_capability;
789 u64 sync_tsf;
790 u32 sync_device_ts;
791 u8 sync_dtim_count;
792 u32 basic_rates;
793 struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
794 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
795 u16 ht_operation_mode;
796 s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
797 u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
798 s32 cqm_rssi_low;
799 s32 cqm_rssi_high;
800 struct ieee80211_chan_req chanreq;
801 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
802 bool qos;
803 bool hidden_ssid;
804 int txpower;
805 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
806 struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
807 bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
808 u16 max_idle_period;
809 bool protected_keep_alive;
810 bool ftm_responder;
811 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
812 /* Multiple BSSID data */
813 bool nontransmitted;
814 struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *tx_bss_conf;
815 u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
816 u8 bssid_index;
817 u8 bssid_indicator;
818 bool ema_ap;
819 u8 profile_periodicity;
820 struct {
821 u32 params;
822 u16 nss_set;
823 } he_oper;
824 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
825 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
826 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
827 u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
828 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
829 enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
830
831 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe tpe;
832
833 u8 pwr_reduction;
834 bool eht_support;
835 bool epcs_support;
836 bool uhr_support;
837
838 bool csa_active;
839
840 bool mu_mimo_owner;
841 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
842
843 bool color_change_active;
844 u8 color_change_color;
845
846 bool ht_ldpc;
847 bool vht_ldpc;
848 bool he_ldpc;
849 bool vht_su_beamformer;
850 bool vht_su_beamformee;
851 bool vht_mu_beamformer;
852 bool vht_mu_beamformee;
853 bool he_su_beamformer;
854 bool he_su_beamformee;
855 bool he_mu_beamformer;
856 bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
857 bool eht_su_beamformer;
858 bool eht_su_beamformee;
859 bool eht_mu_beamformer;
860 bool eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo;
861 bool eht_disable_mcs15;
862
863 u8 bss_param_ch_cnt;
864 u8 bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id;
865
866 u8 s1g_long_beacon_period;
867 };
868
869 /**
870 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
871 *
872 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
873 *
874 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
875 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
876 * number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
877 * number and increasing the sequence number only when the
878 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
879 * assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
880 * for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
881 * that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
882 * If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
883 * assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
884 * 802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
885 * beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
886 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
887 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
888 * station
889 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
890 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
891 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
892 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
893 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
894 * because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
895 * avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
896 * firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
897 * went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
898 * the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
899 * that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
900 * since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
901 * hardware queue.
902 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
903 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
904 * is for the whole aggregation.
905 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
906 * so consider using block ack request (BAR).
907 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
908 * set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
909 * be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
910 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
911 * that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
912 * off-channel operation.
913 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
914 * (header conversion)
915 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
916 * used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
917 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
918 * used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
919 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
920 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
921 * be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
922 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
923 * transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
924 * by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
925 * queue gets full.
926 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
927 * after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
928 * be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
929 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
930 * code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
931 * should kick the MLME state machine.
932 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
933 * MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
934 * status to user space)
935 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
936 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
937 * frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
938 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
939 * the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
940 * in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
941 * handled properly by the device.
942 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
943 * testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
944 * TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
945 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
946 * This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
947 * frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
948 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
949 * when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
950 * an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
951 * the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
952 * PS-Poll responses.
953 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
954 * This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
955 * the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
956 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
957 * would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
958 * monitor injection).
959 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
960 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
961 * any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
962 * This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
963 * behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
964 *
965 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
966 * forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
967 */
968 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
969 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS = BIT(0),
970 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ = BIT(1),
971 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK = BIT(2),
972 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT = BIT(3),
973 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT = BIT(4),
974 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM = BIT(5),
975 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU = BIT(6),
976 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED = BIT(7),
977 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED = BIT(8),
978 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK = BIT(9),
979 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU = BIT(10),
980 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK = BIT(11),
981 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE = BIT(12),
982 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK = BIT(13),
983 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP = BIT(14),
984 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED = BIT(15),
985 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT = BIT(16),
986 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER = BIT(17),
987 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES = BIT(18),
988 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION = BIT(19),
989 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX = BIT(20),
990 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX = BIT(21),
991 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC = BIT(22),
992 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC = BIT(23) | BIT(24),
993 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN = BIT(25),
994 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE = BIT(26),
995 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE = BIT(27),
996 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP = BIT(28),
997 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE = BIT(29),
998 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG = BIT(30),
999 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED = BIT(31),
1000 };
1001
1002 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT 23
1003
1004 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
1005
1006 /**
1007 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
1008 *
1009 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
1010 * protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
1011 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
1012 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
1013 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
1014 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
1015 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
1016 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
1017 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
1018 * used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
1019 * it can be sent out.
1020 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
1021 * has already been assigned to this frame.
1022 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
1023 * relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
1024 * of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
1025 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
1026 * for sequence number assignment
1027 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK: Don't use rate mask for this frame
1028 * which is transmitted due to scanning or offchannel TX, not in normal
1029 * operation on the interface.
1030 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
1031 * frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
1032 * only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
1033 * also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
1034 * is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
1035 * it's intended for an MLD.
1036 *
1037 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
1038 */
1039 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
1040 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO = BIT(0),
1041 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE = BIT(1),
1042 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT = BIT(2),
1043 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU = BIT(3),
1044 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT = BIT(4),
1045 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP = BIT(5),
1046 IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING = BIT(6),
1047 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO = BIT(7),
1048 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER = BIT(8),
1049 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX = BIT(9),
1050 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK = BIT(10),
1051 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK = 0xf0000000,
1052 };
1053
1054 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED 0xf
1055 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC \
1056 u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
1057 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
1058
1059 /**
1060 * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
1061 *
1062 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
1063 *
1064 * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
1065 */
1066 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
1067 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
1068 };
1069
1070 /*
1071 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
1072 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
1073 */
1074 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK | \
1075 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT | \
1076 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU | \
1077 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK | \
1078 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK | \
1079 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER | \
1080 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC | \
1081 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
1082
1083 /**
1084 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
1085 * Rate Control algorithm.
1086 *
1087 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
1088 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
1089 *
1090 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
1091 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
1092 * This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
1093 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
1094 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
1095 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1096 * into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1097 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1098 * Greenfield mode.
1099 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1100 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1101 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1102 * (80+80 isn't supported yet)
1103 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1104 * adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1105 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1106 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1107 */
1108 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1109 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS = BIT(0),
1110 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT = BIT(1),
1111 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(2),
1112
1113 /* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1114 IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS = BIT(3),
1115 IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD = BIT(4),
1116 IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(5),
1117 IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA = BIT(6),
1118 IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI = BIT(7),
1119 IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS = BIT(8),
1120 IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(9),
1121 IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(10),
1122 };
1123
1124
1125 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1126 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1127
1128 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1129 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1130
1131 /* maximum number of rate stages */
1132 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES 4
1133
1134 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1135 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE 4
1136
1137 /**
1138 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1139 *
1140 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1141 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1142 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1143 *
1144 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1145 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1146 *
1147 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1148 * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1149 *
1150 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1151 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1152 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1153 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1154 * information::
1155 *
1156 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1157 *
1158 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1159 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1160 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1161 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1162 * information should then contain::
1163 *
1164 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1165 *
1166 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1167 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1168 */
1169 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1170 s8 idx;
1171 u16 count:5,
1172 flags:11;
1173 } __packed;
1174
1175 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY 31
1176
ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1177 static inline bool ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1178 {
1179 return rate->idx >= 0 && rate->count > 0;
1180 }
1181
ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate,u8 mcs,u8 nss)1182 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1183 u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1184 {
1185 WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1186 WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1187 rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1188 }
1189
1190 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1191 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1192 {
1193 return rate->idx & 0xF;
1194 }
1195
1196 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)1197 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1198 {
1199 return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1200 }
1201
1202 /**
1203 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1204 *
1205 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1206 * (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1207 * (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1208 * (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1209 *
1210 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1211 * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1212 * not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1213 * link the frame will be transmitted on
1214 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1215 * @status_data: internal data for TX status handling, assigned privately,
1216 * see also &enum ieee80211_status_data for the internal documentation
1217 * @status_data_idr: indicates status data is IDR allocated ID for ack frame
1218 * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1219 * @control: union part for control data
1220 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1221 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1222 * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1223 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1224 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1225 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1226 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1227 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1228 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1229 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1230 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1231 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1232 * @pad: padding
1233 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1234 * @status: union part for status data
1235 * @status.rates: attempted rates
1236 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1237 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1238 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1239 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1240 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1241 * used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1242 * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1243 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1244 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1245 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1246 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1247 */
1248 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1249 /* common information */
1250 u32 flags;
1251 u32 band:3,
1252 status_data_idr:1,
1253 status_data:13,
1254 hw_queue:4,
1255 tx_time_est:10;
1256 /* 1 free bit */
1257
1258 union {
1259 struct {
1260 union {
1261 /* rate control */
1262 struct {
1263 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1264 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1265 s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1266 u8 use_rts:1;
1267 u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1268 u8 short_preamble:1;
1269 u8 skip_table:1;
1270
1271 /* for injection only (bitmap) */
1272 u8 antennas:2;
1273
1274 /* 14 bits free */
1275 };
1276 /* only needed before rate control */
1277 unsigned long jiffies;
1278 };
1279 /* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1280 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1281 struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1282 u32 flags;
1283 codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1284 } control;
1285 struct {
1286 u64 cookie;
1287 } ack;
1288 struct {
1289 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1290 s32 ack_signal;
1291 u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1292 u8 ampdu_len;
1293 u8 antenna;
1294 u8 pad;
1295 u16 tx_time;
1296 u8 flags;
1297 u8 pad2;
1298 void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)];
1299 } status;
1300 struct {
1301 struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1302 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1303 u8 pad[4];
1304
1305 void *rate_driver_data[
1306 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1307 };
1308 void *driver_data[
1309 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1310 };
1311 };
1312
1313 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info,u16 tx_time_est)1314 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1315 {
1316 /* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1317 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1318 */
1319 info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1320 return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1321 }
1322
1323 static inline u16
ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1324 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1325 {
1326 return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1327 }
1328
1329 /***
1330 * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1331 *
1332 * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1333 * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1334 *
1335 * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1336 * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1337 * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1338 * corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1339 * that was used when sending the packet.
1340 */
1341 struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1342 struct rate_info rate_idx;
1343 u8 try_count;
1344 u8 tx_power_idx;
1345 };
1346
1347 /**
1348 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1349 *
1350 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1351 * @info: Basic tx status information
1352 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1353 * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1354 * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1355 * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1356 * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1357 * Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1358 * frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1359 */
1360 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1361 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1362 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1363 struct sk_buff *skb;
1364 struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1365 ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1366 u8 n_rates;
1367
1368 struct list_head *free_list;
1369 };
1370
1371 /**
1372 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1373 *
1374 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1375 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1376 * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1377 *
1378 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1379 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1380 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1381 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1382 */
1383 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1384 const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1385 size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1386 const u8 *common_ies;
1387 size_t common_ie_len;
1388 };
1389
1390
IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff * skb)1391 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1392 {
1393 return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1394 }
1395
IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff * skb)1396 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1397 {
1398 return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1399 }
1400
1401 /**
1402 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1403 *
1404 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1405 *
1406 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1407 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1408 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1409 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1410 *
1411 * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1412 * driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1413 * any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1414 */
1415 static inline void
ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1416 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1417 {
1418 int i;
1419
1420 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1421 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1422 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1423 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1424 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1425 /* clear the rate counts */
1426 for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1427 info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1428 memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1429 }
1430
1431
1432 /**
1433 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1434 *
1435 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1436 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1437 * Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1438 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1439 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1440 * verification has been done by the hardware.
1441 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1442 * If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1443 * hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1444 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1445 * flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1446 * Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1447 * is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1448 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1449 * de-duplication by itself.
1450 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1451 * the frame.
1452 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1453 * the frame.
1454 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1455 * field) is valid if this field is non-zero, and the position
1456 * where the timestamp was sampled depends on the value.
1457 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1458 * field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1459 * was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1460 * merging.
1461 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1462 * field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1463 * (including FCS) was received.
1464 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1465 * field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1466 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64: The timestamp passed in the RX status @mactime
1467 * is only for use in the radiotap timestamp header, not otherwise a valid
1468 * @mactime value. Note this is a separate flag so that we continue to see
1469 * %RX_FLAG_MACTIME as unset. Also note that in this case the timestamp is
1470 * reported to be 64 bits wide, not just 32.
1471 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1472 * Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1473 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1474 * number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1475 * each A-MPDU
1476 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1477 * subframes of a single A-MPDU
1478 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1479 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1480 * on this subframe
1481 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1482 * done by the hardware
1483 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1484 * processing it in any regular way.
1485 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1486 * them for sniffing purposes.
1487 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1488 * monitor interfaces.
1489 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1490 * them for sniffing purposes.
1491 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1492 * subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1493 * All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1494 * if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1495 * the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1496 * deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1497 * subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1498 * either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1499 * interleaved with other frames.
1500 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1501 * skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1502 * If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1503 * to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1504 * data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1505 * in the skb.
1506 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1507 * This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1508 * the first subframe.
1509 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1510 * be done in the hardware.
1511 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1512 * frame
1513 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1514 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1515 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1516 *
1517 * - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1518 * - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1519 * - DATA3_CODING
1520 * - DATA5_GI
1521 * - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1522 * - DATA6_NSTS
1523 * - DATA3_STBC
1524 *
1525 * from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1526 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1527 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1528 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1529 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1530 * the "0-length PSDU" field included there. The value for it is
1531 * in &struct ieee80211_rx_status. Note that if this value isn't
1532 * known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1533 * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1534 * hardware or driver)
1535 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VHT: VHT radiotap data is present
1536 */
1537 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1538 RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR = BIT(0),
1539 RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED = BIT(1),
1540 RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR = BIT(2),
1541 RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED = BIT(3),
1542 RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED = BIT(4),
1543 RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC = BIT(5),
1544 RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC = BIT(6),
1545 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64 = BIT(7),
1546 RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL = BIT(8),
1547 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS = BIT(9),
1548 RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED = BIT(10),
1549 RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED = BIT(11),
1550 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN = BIT(12),
1551 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST = BIT(13),
1552 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR = BIT(14),
1553 /* one free bit at 15 */
1554 RX_FLAG_MACTIME = BIT(16) | BIT(17),
1555 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START = 1 << 16,
1556 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START = 2 << 16,
1557 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END = 3 << 16,
1558 RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR = BIT(18),
1559 RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE = BIT(19),
1560 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END = BIT(20),
1561 RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED = BIT(21),
1562 RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN = BIT(22),
1563 RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED = BIT(23),
1564 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT = BIT(24),
1565 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN = BIT(25),
1566 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE = BIT(26),
1567 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU = BIT(27),
1568 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG = BIT(28),
1569 RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU = BIT(29),
1570 RX_FLAG_8023 = BIT(30),
1571 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VHT = BIT(31),
1572 };
1573
1574 /**
1575 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1576 *
1577 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1578 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1579 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1580 * if the driver fills this value it should add
1581 * %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1582 * to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1583 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1584 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1585 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1586 */
1587 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1588 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE = BIT(0),
1589 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI = BIT(2),
1590 RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF = BIT(3),
1591 RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK = BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1592 RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC = BIT(6),
1593 RX_ENC_FLAG_BF = BIT(7),
1594 };
1595
1596 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT 4
1597
1598 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1599 RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1600 RX_ENC_HT,
1601 RX_ENC_VHT,
1602 RX_ENC_HE,
1603 RX_ENC_EHT,
1604 RX_ENC_UHR,
1605 };
1606
1607 /**
1608 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1609 *
1610 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1611 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1612 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1613 *
1614 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1615 * (TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1616 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1617 * needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1618 * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1619 * needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1620 * Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1621 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1622 * it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1623 * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1624 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1625 * This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1626 * for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1627 * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1628 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1629 * unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1630 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1631 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1632 * values were filled.
1633 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1634 * support dB or unspecified units)
1635 * @antenna: antenna used
1636 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1637 * HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1638 * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE, EHT and UHR only)
1639 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1640 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1641 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1642 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1643 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1644 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1645 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1646 * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1647 * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1648 * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1649 * @uhr: UHR specific rate information
1650 * @uhr.ru: UHR RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1651 * @uhr.gi: UHR GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1652 * @uhr.elr: UHR ELR MCS was used
1653 * @uhr.im: UHR interference mitigation was used
1654 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1655 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1656 * each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1657 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1658 * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1659 * is set only when connection is MLO.
1660 * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1661 * @link_valid.
1662 */
1663 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1664 u64 mactime;
1665 union {
1666 u64 boottime_ns;
1667 ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1668 };
1669 u32 device_timestamp;
1670 u32 ampdu_reference;
1671 u32 flag;
1672 u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1673 u8 enc_flags;
1674 u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1675 union {
1676 struct {
1677 u8 he_ru:3;
1678 u8 he_gi:2;
1679 u8 he_dcm:1;
1680 };
1681 struct {
1682 u8 ru:4;
1683 u8 gi:2;
1684 } eht;
1685 struct {
1686 u8 ru:4;
1687 u8 gi:2;
1688 u8 elr:1;
1689 u8 im:1;
1690 } uhr;
1691 };
1692 u8 rate_idx;
1693 u8 nss;
1694 u8 rx_flags;
1695 u8 band;
1696 u8 antenna;
1697 s8 signal;
1698 u8 chains;
1699 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1700 u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1701 u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1702 };
1703
1704 static inline u32
ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status * rx_status)1705 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1706 {
1707 return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1708 (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1709 }
1710
1711 /**
1712 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1713 *
1714 * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1715 *
1716 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1717 * to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1718 * or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1719 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1720 * This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1721 * meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1722 * transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1723 * Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1724 * driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1725 * for more.
1726 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1727 * the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1728 * may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1729 * be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1730 * it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1731 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1732 * operating channel.
1733 */
1734 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1735 IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR = (1<<0),
1736 IEEE80211_CONF_PS = (1<<1),
1737 IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE = (1<<2),
1738 IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL = (1<<3),
1739 };
1740
1741
1742 /**
1743 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1744 *
1745 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1746 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1747 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1748 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1749 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1750 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1751 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1752 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1753 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1754 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1755 */
1756 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1757 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS = BIT(1),
1758 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL = BIT(2),
1759 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR = BIT(3),
1760 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS = BIT(4),
1761 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER = BIT(5),
1762 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(6),
1763 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS = BIT(7),
1764 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE = BIT(8),
1765 };
1766
1767 /**
1768 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1769 *
1770 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1771 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1772 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1773 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1774 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1775 */
1776 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1777 IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1778 IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1779 IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1780 IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1781
1782 /* keep last */
1783 IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1784 };
1785
1786 /**
1787 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1788 *
1789 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1790 *
1791 * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1792 *
1793 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1794 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1795 * in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1796 * has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1797 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1798 * powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1799 * the CONF_PS flag is set.
1800 *
1801 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1802 * value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1803 *
1804 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1805 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1806 *
1807 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1808 * (a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1809 * but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1810 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1811 * frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1812 * number of transmissions not the number of retries
1813 *
1814 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1815 * %IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1816 * configured for an HT channel.
1817 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1818 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1819 */
1820 struct ieee80211_conf {
1821 u32 flags;
1822 int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1823
1824 u16 listen_interval;
1825 u8 ps_dtim_period;
1826
1827 u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1828
1829 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1830 bool radar_enabled;
1831 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1832 };
1833
1834 /**
1835 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1836 *
1837 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1838 * operation.
1839 *
1840 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1841 * Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1842 * announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1843 * the driver passed into mac80211.
1844 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1845 * rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1846 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1847 * scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1848 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1849 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1850 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1851 * current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1852 * channel, expressed in TU.
1853 * @link_id: the link ID of the link doing the channel switch, 0 for non-MLO
1854 */
1855 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1856 u64 timestamp;
1857 u32 device_timestamp;
1858 bool block_tx;
1859 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1860 u8 count;
1861 u8 link_id;
1862 u32 delay;
1863 };
1864
1865 /**
1866 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1867 *
1868 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1869 * on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1870 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1871 * monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1872 * connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1873 * provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1874 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1875 * interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1876 * but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1877 * only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1878 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1879 * and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1880 * this is not pure P2P vif.
1881 * @IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE: The driver indicates that EML operation is
1882 * enabled for the interface.
1883 * @IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW: Ignore wider bandwidth OFDMA
1884 * operation on this interface and request a channel context without
1885 * the AP definition. Use this e.g. because the device is able to
1886 * handle OFDMA (downlink and trigger for uplink) on a per-AP basis.
1887 * @IEEE80211_VIF_REMOVE_AP_AFTER_DISASSOC: indicates that the AP sta should
1888 * be removed only after setting the vif as unassociated, and not the
1889 * opposite. Only relevant for STA vifs.
1890 */
1891 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1892 IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER = BIT(0),
1893 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI = BIT(1),
1894 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD = BIT(2),
1895 IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE = BIT(3),
1896 IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE = BIT(4),
1897 IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW = BIT(5),
1898 IEEE80211_VIF_REMOVE_AP_AFTER_DISASSOC = BIT(6),
1899 };
1900
1901
1902 /**
1903 * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1904 *
1905 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1906 * The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1907 * It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1908 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1909 * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1910 * The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1911 * mac80211.
1912 */
1913
1914 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1915 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED = BIT(0),
1916 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR = BIT(1),
1917 IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED = BIT(2),
1918 };
1919
1920 /**
1921 * struct ieee80211_eml_params - EHT Operating mode notification parameters
1922 *
1923 * EML Operating mode notification parameters received in the Operating mode
1924 * notification frame. This struct is used as a container to pass the info to
1925 * the underlay driver.
1926 *
1927 * @link_id: the link ID where the Operating mode notification frame has been
1928 * received.
1929 * @control: EML control field defined in P802.11be section 9.4.1.76.
1930 * @link_bitmap: eMLSR/eMLMR enabled links defined in P802.11be
1931 * section 9.4.1.76.
1932 * @emlmr_mcs_map_count: eMLMR number of valid mcs_map_bw fields according to
1933 * P802.11be section 9.4.1.76 (valid if eMLMR mode control bit is set).
1934 * @emlmr_mcs_map_bw: eMLMR supported MCS and NSS set subfileds defined in
1935 * P802.11be section 9.4.1.76 (valid if eMLMR mode control bit is set).
1936 */
1937 struct ieee80211_eml_params {
1938 u8 link_id;
1939 u8 control;
1940 u16 link_bitmap;
1941 u8 emlmr_mcs_map_count;
1942 u8 emlmr_mcs_map_bw[9];
1943 };
1944
1945 /**
1946 * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1947 * @assoc: association status
1948 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1949 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1950 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1951 * offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1952 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1953 * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001j.
1954 * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
1955 * P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001i.
1956 * @mld_capa_op: MLD Capabilities and Operations per P802.11be_D4.1
1957 * Figure 9-1001k
1958 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1959 * may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1960 * The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1961 * to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1962 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1963 * may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1964 * array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1965 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1966 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1967 * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1968 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1969 * hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1970 * your driver/device needs to do.
1971 * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1972 * (station mode only)
1973 */
1974 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1975 /* association related data */
1976 bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1977 bool ibss_creator;
1978 bool ps;
1979 u16 aid;
1980 u16 eml_cap;
1981 u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
1982 u16 mld_capa_op;
1983
1984 __be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1985 int arp_addr_cnt;
1986 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1987 size_t ssid_len;
1988 bool s1g;
1989 bool idle;
1990 u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1991 };
1992
1993 #define IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS 8
1994
1995 /**
1996 * struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm - negotiated TID to link map info
1997 *
1998 * @downlink: bitmap of active links per TID for downlink, or 0 if mapping for
1999 * this TID is not included.
2000 * @uplink: bitmap of active links per TID for uplink, or 0 if mapping for this
2001 * TID is not included.
2002 * @valid: info is valid or not.
2003 */
2004 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm {
2005 u16 downlink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
2006 u16 uplink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
2007 bool valid;
2008 };
2009
2010 /**
2011 * enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res - return value for negotiated TTLM handling
2012 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT: accept the request
2013 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT: reject the request
2014 * @NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED: reject and suggest a new mapping
2015 */
2016 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res {
2017 NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT,
2018 NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT,
2019 NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED
2020 };
2021
2022 /**
2023 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
2024 *
2025 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
2026 * use during the life of a virtual interface.
2027 *
2028 * @type: type of this virtual interface
2029 * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
2030 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
2031 * or the BSS we're associated to
2032 * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
2033 * indexed by link ID
2034 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
2035 * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
2036 * The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
2037 * API calls meant for that purpose.
2038 * @dormant_links: subset of the valid links that are disabled/suspended
2039 * due to advertised or negotiated TTLM respectively.
2040 * 0 for non-MLO.
2041 * @suspended_links: subset of dormant_links representing links that are
2042 * suspended due to negotiated TTLM, and could be activated in the
2043 * future by tearing down the TTLM negotiation.
2044 * 0 for non-MLO.
2045 * @neg_ttlm: negotiated TID to link mapping info.
2046 * see &struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm.
2047 * @addr: address of this interface
2048 * @addr_valid: indicates if the address is actively used. Set to false for
2049 * passive monitor interfaces, true in all other cases.
2050 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
2051 * interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
2052 * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
2053 * vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
2054 * can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
2055 * for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
2056 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
2057 * these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
2058 * or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
2059 * at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
2060 * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
2061 * These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
2062 * .change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
2063 * within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
2064 * restrictions.
2065 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
2066 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
2067 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
2068 * interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
2069 * monitor interface (if that is requested.)
2070 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
2071 * interface.
2072 * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
2073 * for this interface.
2074 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2075 * sizeof(void \*).
2076 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
2077 * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
2078 * &enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
2079 */
2080 struct ieee80211_vif {
2081 enum nl80211_iftype type;
2082 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
2083 struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
2084 struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2085 u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links, suspended_links;
2086 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm neg_ttlm;
2087 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2088 bool addr_valid;
2089 bool p2p;
2090
2091 u8 cab_queue;
2092 u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
2093
2094 struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
2095
2096 netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2097 u32 driver_flags;
2098 u32 offload_flags;
2099
2100 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
2101 struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
2102 #endif
2103
2104 bool probe_req_reg;
2105 bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
2106
2107 /* must be last */
2108 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2109 };
2110
2111 /**
2112 * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
2113 * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
2114 * Return: the usable link bitmap
2115 */
ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2116 static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2117 {
2118 return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
2119 }
2120
2121 /**
2122 * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
2123 * @vif: the vif
2124 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
2125 */
ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2126 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2127 {
2128 /* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
2129 return vif->valid_links != 0;
2130 }
2131
2132 /**
2133 * ieee80211_vif_link_active - check if a given link is active
2134 * @vif: the vif
2135 * @link_id: the link ID to check
2136 * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD and the link is active, or if
2137 * the vif is not an MLD and the link ID is 0; %false otherwise.
2138 */
ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)2139 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2140 unsigned int link_id)
2141 {
2142 if (!ieee80211_vif_is_mld(vif))
2143 return link_id == 0;
2144 return vif->active_links & BIT(link_id);
2145 }
2146
2147 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id) \
2148 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++) \
2149 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \
2150 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \
2151 (link = link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)))
2152
ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2153 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2154 {
2155 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
2156 return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
2157 #endif
2158 return false;
2159 }
2160
2161 /**
2162 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
2163 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
2164 *
2165 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2166 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
2167 *
2168 * Return: pointer to the wdev, or %NULL if the given wdev isn't
2169 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
2170 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
2171 */
2172 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
2173
2174 /**
2175 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
2176 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
2177 *
2178 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2179 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
2180 * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
2181 *
2182 * Return: pointer to the wdev
2183 */
2184 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
2185
lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)2186 static inline bool lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2187 {
2188 return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->wiphy->mtx);
2189 }
2190
2191 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id) \
2192 rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \
2193 lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2194
2195 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id) \
2196 rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id], \
2197 lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2198
2199 /**
2200 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
2201 *
2202 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
2203 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
2204 *
2205 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
2206 * driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
2207 * particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
2208 * will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
2209 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
2210 * the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
2211 * generation in software.
2212 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
2213 * that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
2214 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
2215 * CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
2216 * (MFP) to be done in software.
2217 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
2218 * if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
2219 * itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
2220 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
2221 * not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
2222 * MIC.
2223 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
2224 * management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
2225 * crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
2226 * properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
2227 * fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
2228 * RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2229 * %IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2230 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2231 * driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2232 * only for management frames (MFP).
2233 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2234 * driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2235 * be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2236 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2237 * a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2238 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2239 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2240 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2241 * for a AES_CMAC or a AES_GMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence
2242 * number generation only
2243 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs can be used with this key
2244 * (set by mac80211 from the sta->spp_amsdu flag)
2245 */
2246 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2247 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT = BIT(0),
2248 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV = BIT(1),
2249 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC = BIT(2),
2250 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE = BIT(3),
2251 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX = BIT(4),
2252 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE = BIT(5),
2253 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT = BIT(6),
2254 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM = BIT(7),
2255 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE = BIT(8),
2256 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX = BIT(9),
2257 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE = BIT(10),
2258 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU = BIT(11),
2259 };
2260
2261 /**
2262 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2263 *
2264 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2265 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2266 *
2267 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2268 * wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2269 * encrypted in hardware.
2270 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2271 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2272 * needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2273 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2274 * @keyidx: the key index (0-7)
2275 * @keylen: key material length
2276 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2277 * data block:
2278 * - Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2279 * - Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2280 * - Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2281 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2282 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2283 * @link_id: the link ID, 0 for non-MLO, or -1 for pairwise keys
2284 */
2285 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2286 atomic64_t tx_pn;
2287 u32 cipher;
2288 u8 icv_len;
2289 u8 iv_len;
2290 u8 hw_key_idx;
2291 s8 keyidx;
2292 u16 flags;
2293 s8 link_id;
2294 u8 keylen;
2295 u8 key[];
2296 };
2297
2298 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN 16
2299
2300 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2301 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2302
2303 /**
2304 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2305 *
2306 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2307 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2308 * reverse order than in packet)
2309 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2310 * reverse order than in packet)
2311 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2312 * reverse order than in packet)
2313 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2314 * reverse order than in packet)
2315 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2316 */
2317 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2318 union {
2319 struct {
2320 u32 iv32;
2321 u16 iv16;
2322 } tkip;
2323 struct {
2324 u8 pn[6];
2325 } ccmp;
2326 struct {
2327 u8 pn[6];
2328 } aes_cmac;
2329 struct {
2330 u8 pn[6];
2331 } aes_gmac;
2332 struct {
2333 u8 pn[6];
2334 } gcmp;
2335 struct {
2336 u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2337 u8 seq_len;
2338 } hw;
2339 };
2340 };
2341
2342 /**
2343 * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2344 *
2345 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2346 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2347 *
2348 * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2349 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2350 */
2351 enum set_key_cmd {
2352 SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2353 };
2354
2355 /**
2356 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2357 *
2358 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2359 * this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2360 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2361 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2362 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2363 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2364 */
2365 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2366 /* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2367 IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2368 IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2369 IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2370 IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2371 IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2372 };
2373
2374 /**
2375 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2376 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2377 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2378 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2379 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2380 * (including 80+80 MHz)
2381 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2382 *
2383 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2384 * correctly, the values must be sorted.
2385 */
2386 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2387 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2388 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2389 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2390 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2391 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2392 };
2393
2394 #define IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_MAX IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320
2395
2396 /**
2397 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2398 *
2399 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2400 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2401 * Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2402 */
2403 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2404 struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2405 struct {
2406 s8 idx;
2407 u8 count;
2408 u8 count_cts;
2409 u8 count_rts;
2410 u16 flags;
2411 } rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2412 };
2413
2414 /**
2415 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2416 *
2417 * Used to configure txpower for station.
2418 *
2419 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2420 * to the STA.
2421 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2422 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2423 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2424 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2425 * per peer TPC.
2426 */
2427 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2428 s16 power;
2429 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2430 };
2431
2432 /**
2433 * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2434 *
2435 * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2436 * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2437 *
2438 * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2439 * This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2440 * For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2441 *
2442 * * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2443 * A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2444 * * If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2445 * size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2446 *
2447 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2448 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2449 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2450 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2451 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2452 */
2453 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2454 u16 max_amsdu_len;
2455
2456 u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2457 u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2458 };
2459
2460 /**
2461 * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2462 * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2463 * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2464 *
2465 * @sta: reference to owning STA
2466 * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2467 * in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2468 * from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2469 * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2470 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2471 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2472 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2473 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2474 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2475 * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2476 * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2477 * @uhr_cap: UHR capabilities of this STA
2478 * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities of this STA
2479 * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation
2480 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2481 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2482 * station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2483 * notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2484 * the station moves to associated state.
2485 * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2486 *
2487 */
2488 struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2489 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2490
2491 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2492 u8 link_id;
2493 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2494
2495 u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2496 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2497 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2498 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2499 struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2500 struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2501 struct ieee80211_sta_uhr_cap uhr_cap;
2502 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
2503
2504 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2505
2506 u8 rx_nss;
2507 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2508 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2509 };
2510
2511 /**
2512 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2513 *
2514 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2515 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2516 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2517 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2518 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2519 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2520 * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2521 * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2522 *
2523 * @addr: MAC address
2524 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2525 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2526 * that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2527 * Can be modified by driver.
2528 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2529 * otherwise always false)
2530 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2531 * sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2532 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2533 * if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2534 * IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2535 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2536 * @rates: rate control selection table
2537 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2538 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2539 * valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2540 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2541 * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2542 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2543 * A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2544 * unlimited.
2545 * @eml_cap: EML capabilities of this MLO station
2546 * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2547 * For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2548 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2549 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2550 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2551 * is used for non-data frames
2552 * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2553 * specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2554 * link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2555 * the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2556 * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2557 * i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2558 * would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2559 * STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2560 * @deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2561 * would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2562 * by the AP.
2563 * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2564 * @spp_amsdu: indicates whether the STA uses SPP A-MSDU or not.
2565 * @epp_peer: indicates that the peer is an EPP peer.
2566 */
2567 struct ieee80211_sta {
2568 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2569 u16 aid;
2570 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2571 bool wme;
2572 u8 uapsd_queues;
2573 u8 max_sp;
2574 struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2575 bool tdls;
2576 bool tdls_initiator;
2577 bool mfp;
2578 bool mlo;
2579 bool spp_amsdu;
2580 u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2581 u16 eml_cap;
2582
2583 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2584
2585 bool support_p2p_ps;
2586
2587 struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2588
2589 u16 valid_links;
2590 bool epp_peer;
2591 struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2592 struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2593
2594 /* must be last */
2595 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2596 };
2597
2598 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2599 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2600 #else
lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta * pubsta)2601 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2602 {
2603 return true;
2604 }
2605 #endif
2606
2607 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id) \
2608 rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id], \
2609 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2610
2611 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id) \
2612 rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id], \
2613 lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2614
2615 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id) \
2616 for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++) \
2617 if ((!(vif)->active_links || \
2618 (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) && \
2619 ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)))
2620
2621 /**
2622 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2623 *
2624 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2625 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2626 *
2627 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2628 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2629 */
2630 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2631 STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2632 };
2633
2634 /**
2635 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2636 *
2637 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2638 * it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2639 */
2640 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2641 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2642 };
2643
2644 /**
2645 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2646 *
2647 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2648 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2649 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2650 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2651 * @ac: the AC for this queue
2652 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2653 *
2654 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2655 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2656 */
2657 struct ieee80211_txq {
2658 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2659 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2660 u8 tid;
2661 u8 ac;
2662
2663 /* must be last */
2664 u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2665 };
2666
2667 /**
2668 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2669 *
2670 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2671 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2672 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2673 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2674 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2675 *
2676 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2677 * The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2678 * controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2679 * should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2680 * will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2681 * algorithm.
2682 * Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2683 * callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2684 * the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2685 * @use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2686 * timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2687 * CCK frames.
2688 *
2689 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2690 * Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2691 * the FCS at the end.
2692 *
2693 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2694 * Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2695 * for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2696 * rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2697 * to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2698 * multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2699 * the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2700 *
2701 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2702 * Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2703 * expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2704 * If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2705 *
2706 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2707 * Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2708 * one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2709 * between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2710 *
2711 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2712 * Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2713 * Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2714 *
2715 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2716 * Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2717 *
2718 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2719 * Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2720 *
2721 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2722 * Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2723 * stack support for dynamic PS.
2724 *
2725 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2726 * Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2727 *
2728 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2729 * Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2730 *
2731 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2732 * Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2733 * the stack.
2734 *
2735 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2736 * The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2737 * periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2738 *
2739 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2740 * This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2741 * dtim_period).
2742 *
2743 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2744 * per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2745 * the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2746 * to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2747 * possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2748 * only in that case.
2749 *
2750 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2751 * autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2752 * this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2753 * stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2754 * Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2755 * the PS mode of connected stations.
2756 *
2757 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2758 * setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2759 * software.
2760 *
2761 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2762 * a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2763 * active interfaces.
2764 *
2765 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_VIRTUAL_MONITOR: The driver would like to be informed
2766 * of any monitor interface, as well as their configured channel.
2767 * This is useful for supporting multiple monitor interfaces on different
2768 * channels.
2769 *
2770 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2771 * be created. It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2772 * desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2773 *
2774 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2775 * crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2776 * try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2777 * the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2778 * supported cipher suites.
2779 *
2780 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2781 * this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2782 * for frames.
2783 *
2784 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2785 * queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2786 * for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2787 * control for more details.
2788 *
2789 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2790 * selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2791 *
2792 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2793 * P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2794 * is supported.
2795 *
2796 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2797 * only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2798 *
2799 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2800 * and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2801 * using aggregation for such frames.)
2802 *
2803 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2804 * for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2805 * is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2806 * CSA frame.
2807 *
2808 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2809 * or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2810 *
2811 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2812 * in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2813 *
2814 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2815 * than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2816 *
2817 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2818 * within A-MPDU.
2819 *
2820 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2821 * for sent beacons.
2822 *
2823 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2824 * station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2825 * by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2826 * from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2827 *
2828 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2829 * reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2830 * order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2831 * timeout.
2832 *
2833 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2834 * which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2835 *
2836 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2837 * A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2838 * When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2839 * limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2840 * max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2841 *
2842 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2843 * skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2844 *
2845 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2846 * by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2847 * drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2848 * is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2849 *
2850 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2851 * The stack will not do fragmentation.
2852 * The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2853 *
2854 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2855 * TDLS links.
2856 *
2857 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2858 * support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2859 *
2860 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2861 * course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2862 *
2863 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2864 * extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2865 * the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2866 * but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2867 * See also the documentation for that flag.
2868 *
2869 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2870 * MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2871 * TXQs to start with.
2872 *
2873 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2874 * length in tx status information
2875 *
2876 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2877 *
2878 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2879 * only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2880 *
2881 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2882 * aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2883 * A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2884 *
2885 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2886 * offload
2887 *
2888 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2889 * offload
2890 *
2891 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2892 * decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2893 * If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2894 * usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2895 * the stack.
2896 *
2897 * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2898 * collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2899 *
2900 * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2901 * multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2902 *
2903 * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING: HW requires disabling puncturing in EHT
2904 * and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
2905 *
2906 * @IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA: HW/driver handles quieting for CSA, so
2907 * no need to stop queues. This really should be set by a driver that
2908 * implements MLO, so operation can continue on other links when one
2909 * link is switching.
2910 *
2911 * @IEEE80211_HW_STRICT: strictly enforce certain things mandated by the spec
2912 * but otherwise ignored/worked around for interoperability. This is a
2913 * HW flag so drivers can opt in according to their own control, e.g. in
2914 * testing.
2915 *
2916 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2917 */
2918 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2919 IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2920 IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2921 IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2922 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2923 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2924 IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2925 IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2926 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2927 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2928 IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2929 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2930 IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2931 IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2932 IEEE80211_HW_NO_VIRTUAL_MONITOR,
2933 IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2934 IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2935 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2936 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2937 IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2938 IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2939 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2940 IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2941 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2942 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2943 IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2944 IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2945 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2946 IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2947 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2948 IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2949 IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2950 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2951 IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2952 IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2953 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2954 IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2955 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2956 IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2957 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2958 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2959 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2960 IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2961 IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2962 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2963 IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2964 IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2965 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2966 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2967 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2968 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2969 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2970 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2971 IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2972 IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2973 IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING,
2974 IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA,
2975 IEEE80211_HW_STRICT,
2976
2977 /* keep last, obviously */
2978 NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2979 };
2980
2981 /**
2982 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2983 *
2984 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2985 * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2986 *
2987 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2988 * 802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2989 * members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2990 * and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2991 * bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2992 *
2993 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2994 *
2995 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2996 * along with this structure.
2997 *
2998 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2999 *
3000 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
3001 * for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
3002 *
3003 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
3004 * Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
3005 *
3006 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
3007 * only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
3008 *
3009 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
3010 * that HW supports
3011 *
3012 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
3013 * data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
3014 * queues need to have configurable access parameters.
3015 *
3016 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
3017 * If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
3018 * set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
3019 *
3020 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
3021 * within &struct ieee80211_vif.
3022 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
3023 * within &struct ieee80211_sta.
3024 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
3025 * within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
3026 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
3027 * within @struct ieee80211_txq.
3028 *
3029 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
3030 * can handle.
3031 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
3032 * the hw can report back.
3033 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
3034 *
3035 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
3036 * sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
3037 * aggregation.
3038 * This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
3039 * number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
3040 * it shouldn't be set.
3041 *
3042 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
3043 * aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
3044 * advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
3045 * the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
3046 * with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
3047 * For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
3048 *
3049 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
3050 * of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
3051 *
3052 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
3053 * (if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
3054 *
3055 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
3056 * reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
3057 * include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
3058 * adding _BW is supported today.
3059 *
3060 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
3061 * the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
3062 * Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
3063 *
3064 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
3065 * @units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
3066 * field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
3067 * device_timestamp.
3068 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
3069 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
3070 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
3071 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
3072 * radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
3073 *
3074 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
3075 * from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
3076 * other features will be rejected during HW registration.
3077 *
3078 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
3079 * for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
3080 * enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
3081 * Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
3082 * that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
3083 * neither enabled.
3084 *
3085 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
3086 * deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
3087 * Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
3088 *
3089 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
3090 * device.
3091 *
3092 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
3093 * them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
3094 * unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
3095 *
3096 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
3097 * refilling deficit of each TXQ.
3098 *
3099 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
3100 *
3101 * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
3102 * The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
3103 * The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
3104 *
3105 * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
3106 */
3107 struct ieee80211_hw {
3108 struct ieee80211_conf conf;
3109 struct wiphy *wiphy;
3110 const char *rate_control_algorithm;
3111 void *priv;
3112 unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
3113 unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
3114 unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
3115 int vif_data_size;
3116 int sta_data_size;
3117 int chanctx_data_size;
3118 int txq_data_size;
3119 u16 queues;
3120 u16 max_listen_interval;
3121 s8 max_signal;
3122 u8 max_rates;
3123 u8 max_report_rates;
3124 u8 max_rate_tries;
3125 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
3126 u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
3127 u8 max_tx_fragments;
3128 u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
3129 u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
3130 u16 radiotap_vht_details;
3131 struct {
3132 int units_pos;
3133 s16 accuracy;
3134 } radiotap_timestamp;
3135 netdev_features_t netdev_features;
3136 u8 uapsd_queues;
3137 u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
3138 u8 max_nan_de_entries;
3139 u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
3140 u8 weight_multiplier;
3141 u32 max_mtu;
3142 const s8 *tx_power_levels;
3143 u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
3144 };
3145
_ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)3146 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3147 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3148 {
3149 return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3150 }
3151 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3152
_ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)3153 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3154 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3155 {
3156 return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3157 }
3158 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3159
3160 /**
3161 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
3162 *
3163 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
3164 * @req: cfg80211 request.
3165 */
3166 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
3167 struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
3168
3169 /* Keep last */
3170 struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
3171 };
3172
3173 /**
3174 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
3175 *
3176 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
3177 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
3178 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
3179 * @status: channel-switch response status
3180 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
3181 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3182 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3183 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
3184 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
3185 */
3186 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
3187 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3188 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
3189 u8 action_code;
3190 u32 status;
3191 u32 timestamp;
3192 u16 switch_time;
3193 u16 switch_timeout;
3194 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
3195 u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
3196 };
3197
3198 /**
3199 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
3200 *
3201 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
3202 *
3203 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
3204 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
3205 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
3206 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
3207 * is already used internally by mac80211.
3208 *
3209 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
3210 */
3211 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
3212
3213 /**
3214 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
3215 *
3216 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
3217 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
3218 */
SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct device * dev)3219 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
3220 {
3221 set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
3222 }
3223
3224 /**
3225 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
3226 *
3227 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
3228 * @addr: the address to set
3229 */
SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const u8 * addr)3230 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
3231 {
3232 memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
3233 }
3234
3235 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3236 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3237 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3238 {
3239 if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
3240 return NULL;
3241
3242 if (c->band >= NUM_NL80211_BANDS)
3243 return NULL;
3244
3245 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
3246 }
3247
3248 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)3249 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3250 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3251 {
3252 if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
3253 return NULL;
3254 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
3255 }
3256
3257 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c,int idx)3258 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3259 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3260 {
3261 if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3262 return NULL;
3263 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3264 }
3265
3266 /**
3267 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3268 * @hw: the hardware
3269 * @skb: the skb
3270 *
3271 * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3272 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3273 */
3274 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3275
3276 /**
3277 * ieee80211_purge_tx_queue - purge TX skb queue
3278 * @hw: the hardware
3279 * @skbs: the skbs
3280 *
3281 * Free a set of transmit skbs. Use this function when device is going to stop
3282 * but some transmit skbs without TX status are still queued.
3283 * This function does not take the list lock and the caller must hold the
3284 * relevant locks to use it.
3285 */
3286 void ieee80211_purge_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3287 struct sk_buff_head *skbs);
3288
3289 /**
3290 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3291 *
3292 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3293 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3294 *
3295 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3296 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3297 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3298 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3299 * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3300 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3301 * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3302 *
3303 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3304 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3305 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3306 *
3307 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3308 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3309 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3310 * hardware key index. You are free to use the full u8 range.
3311 *
3312 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3313 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3314 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3315 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3316 *
3317 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3318 *
3319 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3320 * for it has been uploaded to hardware. The stack will not make any
3321 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3322 * based on the receive flags.
3323 *
3324 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3325 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3326 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3327 * keys.
3328 *
3329 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3330 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3331 * handler.
3332 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3333 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3334 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3335 * rekeying); it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3336 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3337 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3338 *
3339 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3340 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3341 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3342 *
3343 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3344 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3345 * requirements:
3346 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3347 once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3348 2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3349 at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3350 3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3351 encrypted with the new key when also needing
3352 @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3353 4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3354 Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3355 */
3356
3357 /**
3358 * DOC: Powersave support
3359 *
3360 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3361 *
3362 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself;
3363 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3364 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3365 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3366 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3367 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3368 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3369 * it finds traffic directed to it.
3370 *
3371 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3372 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3373 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3374 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3375 * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3376 *
3377 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3378 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3379 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3380 *
3381 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3382 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3383 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3384 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3385 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3386 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3387 * as best as it can; mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3388 *
3389 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3390 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3391 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3392 * the next wakeup. It's a compromise of getting good enough latency when
3393 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3394 * periods.
3395 *
3396 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3397 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3398 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3399 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3400 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3401 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3402 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3403 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3404 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3405 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3406 *
3407 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3408 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3409 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3410 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3411 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3412 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3413 *
3414 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3415 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3416 */
3417
3418 /**
3419 * DOC: Beacon filter support
3420 *
3421 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3422 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3423 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3424 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3425 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3426 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3427 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3428 *
3429 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3430 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3431 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3432 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3433 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3434 *
3435 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3436 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3437 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3438 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3439 *
3440 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3441 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3442 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3443 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3444 *
3445 * - a list of information element IDs
3446 * - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3447 *
3448 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3449 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3450 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3451 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3452 * vendor information elements.
3453 *
3454 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3455 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3456 *
3457 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead. Just make sure nothing
3458 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3459 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3460 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3461 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3462 * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3463 *
3464 *
3465 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3466 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3467 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3468 * the received data packets). This can consist of notifying the host when
3469 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3470 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3471 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3472 * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3473 *
3474 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3475 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3476 * signal strength threshold checking.
3477 */
3478
3479 /**
3480 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3481 *
3482 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3483 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3484 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3485 * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3486 *
3487 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3488 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3489 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3490 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3491 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3492 * hardware flags.
3493 *
3494 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3495 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3496 * turned off otherwise.
3497 *
3498 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3499 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3500 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3501 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3502 */
3503
3504 /**
3505 * DOC: Frame filtering
3506 *
3507 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3508 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3509 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3510 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3511 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3512 *
3513 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3514 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3515 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3516 *
3517 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3518 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3519 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3520 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3521 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3522 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3523 * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3524 *
3525 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3526 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3527 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3528 * or dropped.
3529 *
3530 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3531 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3532 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3533 * the flag, but not clear it.
3534 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3535 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3536 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3537 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3538 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3539 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3540 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3541 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3542 */
3543
3544 /**
3545 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3546 *
3547 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3548 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3549 * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3550 *
3551 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3552 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3553 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3554 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3555 * the driver code.
3556 *
3557 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3558 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3559 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3560 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3561 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3562 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3563 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3564 *
3565 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3566 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3567 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3568 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3569 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3570 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3571 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3572 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3573 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3574 * @sta_notify callback.
3575 *
3576 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3577 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3578 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3579 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3580 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3581 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3582 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3583 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3584 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3585 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3586 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3587 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3588 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3589 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3590 *
3591 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3592 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3593 *
3594 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3595 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3596 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3597 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3598 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3599 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3600 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3601 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3602 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3603 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3604 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3605 *
3606 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3607 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3608 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3609 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3610 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3611 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3612 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3613 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3614 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3615 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames.
3616 * To help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3617 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3618 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3619 * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3620 *
3621 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3622 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3623 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3624 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3625 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3626 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3627 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3628 *
3629 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3630 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3631 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3632 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3633 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3634 *
3635 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3636 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3637 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3638 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3639 */
3640
3641 /**
3642 * DOC: HW queue control
3643 *
3644 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3645 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3646 * was problematic for a few reasons:
3647 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3648 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3649 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3650 *
3651 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3652 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3653 * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3654 *
3655 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3656 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3657 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3658 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3659 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3660 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3661 * the hardware queue.
3662 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3663 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3664 *
3665 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed; multiple virtual
3666 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3667 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3668 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3669 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3670 *
3671 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3672 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3673 * after-DTIM queue for AP: 8
3674 * off-channel queue: 9
3675 *
3676 * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3677 * hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3678 *
3679 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3680 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3681 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3682 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3683 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3684 * vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3685 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3686 *
3687 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3688 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3689 *
3690 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3691 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3692 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3693 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3694 */
3695
3696 /**
3697 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3698 *
3699 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3700 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3701 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3702 * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3703 *
3704 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3705 * by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3706 * multicast address.
3707 *
3708 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3709 * %RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3710 *
3711 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3712 * the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3713 *
3714 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3715 * to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3716 * by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3717 * mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3718 * honour this flag if possible.
3719 *
3720 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3721 * station
3722 *
3723 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3724 *
3725 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3726 *
3727 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3728 *
3729 * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3730 */
3731 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3732 FIF_ALLMULTI = 1<<1,
3733 FIF_FCSFAIL = 1<<2,
3734 FIF_PLCPFAIL = 1<<3,
3735 FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC = 1<<4,
3736 FIF_CONTROL = 1<<5,
3737 FIF_OTHER_BSS = 1<<6,
3738 FIF_PSPOLL = 1<<7,
3739 FIF_PROBE_REQ = 1<<8,
3740 FIF_MCAST_ACTION = 1<<9,
3741 };
3742
3743 /**
3744 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3745 *
3746 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3747 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3748 *
3749 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3750 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3751 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3752 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3753 *
3754 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3755 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3756 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3757 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3758 * call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3759 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3760 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3761 * status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3762 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3763 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3764 * queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3765 * driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3766 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3767 * called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3768 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3769 * session is gone and removes the station.
3770 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3771 * but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3772 * now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3773 * should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3774 */
3775 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3776 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3777 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3778 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3779 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3780 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3781 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3782 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3783 };
3784
3785 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3786 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3787
3788 /**
3789 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3790 *
3791 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3792 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3793 * @tid: tid of the BA session
3794 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3795 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3796 * actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3797 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3798 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3799 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3800 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3801 * valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3802 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3803 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3804 */
3805 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3806 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3807 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3808 u16 tid;
3809 u16 ssn;
3810 u16 buf_size;
3811 bool amsdu;
3812 u16 timeout;
3813 };
3814
3815 /**
3816 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3817 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3818 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3819 * frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3820 */
3821 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3822 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3823 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3824 };
3825
3826 /**
3827 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3828 *
3829 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3830 * to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3831 * information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3832 * flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3833 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3834 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3835 * changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3836 * the peer.
3837 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3838 * by the peer
3839 */
3840 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3841 IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0),
3842 IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED = BIT(1),
3843 IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED = BIT(2),
3844 IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED = BIT(3),
3845 };
3846
3847 /**
3848 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3849 *
3850 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3851 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3852 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3853 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3854 * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3855 *
3856 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3857 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3858 * for sending management frames offchannel.
3859 */
3860 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3861 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3862 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3863 };
3864
3865 /**
3866 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3867 *
3868 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3869 * reconfiguration type was completed.
3870 *
3871 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3872 * (also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3873 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3874 * of wowlan configuration)
3875 */
3876 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3877 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3878 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3879 };
3880
3881 /**
3882 * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3883 * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3884 * only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3885 * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3886 * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3887 * used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3888 * valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3889 * @was_assoc: set if this call is due to deauth/disassoc
3890 * while just having been associated
3891 * @link_id: the link id on which the frame will be TX'ed.
3892 * 0 for a non-MLO connection.
3893 */
3894 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3895 u16 duration;
3896 u16 subtype;
3897 u8 success:1, was_assoc:1;
3898 int link_id;
3899 };
3900
3901 /**
3902 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3903 *
3904 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3905 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3906 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3907 *
3908 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3909 * skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3910 * The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3911 * configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3912 * preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3913 * Must be atomic.
3914 *
3915 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3916 * is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3917 * frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3918 * Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3919 * or zero.
3920 * When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3921 * to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3922 * is added.
3923 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3924 *
3925 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3926 * is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3927 * it must turn off frame reception.)
3928 * May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3929 * an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3930 * you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3931 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3932 *
3933 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3934 * stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3935 * ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3936 * configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3937 * reconfigured at resume time.
3938 * The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3939 * wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3940 * supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3941 * must return 1 from this function.
3942 *
3943 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3944 * now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3945 * functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3946 * to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3947 * will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3948 *
3949 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3950 * modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3951 * supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3952 * in suspend().
3953 *
3954 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3955 * enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3956 * and @stop must be implemented.
3957 * The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3958 * the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3959 * interface is given in the conf parameter.
3960 * The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3961 * negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3962 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3963 *
3964 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3965 * is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3966 * switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3967 * Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3968 * found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3969 *
3970 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3971 * The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3972 * and no monitor interfaces are present.
3973 * When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3974 * must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3975 * the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3976 * MAC address of the device going away.
3977 * Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3978 *
3979 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3980 * function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3981 * This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3982 * if it does. The callback can sleep.
3983 *
3984 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3985 * parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3986 * level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3987 * This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3988 * for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3989 * of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3990 * can sleep.
3991 * Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3992 * are not implemented.
3993 *
3994 * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3995 * (MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3996 * lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3997 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3998 * The callback can sleep.
3999 *
4000 * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
4001 * parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
4002 * individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
4003 * The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
4004 * parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
4005 * non-MLO connections.
4006 * The callback can sleep.
4007 *
4008 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
4009 * This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
4010 * to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
4011 *
4012 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
4013 * See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
4014 * This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
4015 *
4016 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
4017 * This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
4018 * should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
4019 * of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
4020 * which flags are changed.
4021 * This callback can sleep.
4022 *
4023 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
4024 * must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
4025 *
4026 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
4027 * This callback is only called between add_interface and
4028 * remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
4029 * is enabled.
4030 * Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
4031 * The callback can sleep.
4032 *
4033 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
4034 * This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
4035 * which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
4036 * The callback must be atomic.
4037 *
4038 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
4039 * host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
4040 * necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
4041 * After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
4042 * userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
4043 *
4044 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
4045 * WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
4046 * offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
4047 *
4048 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
4049 * the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
4050 * configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
4051 * registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
4052 * that power save is disabled.
4053 * The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
4054 * entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
4055 * at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
4056 * (extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
4057 * When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
4058 * note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
4059 * any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
4060 * This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
4061 * this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
4062 * software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
4063 * capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
4064 * advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
4065 * The callback can sleep.
4066 *
4067 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
4068 * The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
4069 * but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
4070 * ieee80211_scan_completed().
4071 * This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
4072 * scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
4073 * The callback can sleep.
4074 *
4075 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
4076 * specific intervals. The driver must call the
4077 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
4078 * This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
4079 *
4080 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
4081 * In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
4082 *
4083 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
4084 * is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
4085 * The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
4086 * the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
4087 * can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
4088 *
4089 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
4090 * software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
4091 * this notification.
4092 * The callback can sleep.
4093 *
4094 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
4095 * Returns zero if statistics are available.
4096 * The callback can sleep.
4097 *
4098 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
4099 * IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
4100 * IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
4101 * The callback must be atomic.
4102 *
4103 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
4104 * if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
4105 * stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
4106 * should be set as well.
4107 * The callback can sleep.
4108 *
4109 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
4110 * The callback can sleep.
4111 *
4112 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
4113 * AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
4114 *
4115 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
4116 * station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
4117 * returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
4118 * no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
4119 * the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4120 * This callback can sleep.
4121 *
4122 * @vif_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add a debugfs vif
4123 * directory with its files. This callback should be within a
4124 * CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4125 *
4126 * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4127 * when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
4128 * a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4129 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
4130 * with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4131 *
4132 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4133 * when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
4134 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4135 * callback can sleep.
4136 *
4137 * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4138 * when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
4139 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4140 * callback can sleep.
4141 * For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
4142 * station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4143 *
4144 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
4145 * associated station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
4146 * in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
4147 * %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
4148 *
4149 * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
4150 * power for the station.
4151 * This callback can sleep.
4152 *
4153 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
4154 * station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
4155 * This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
4156 * It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
4157 * up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
4158 * isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
4159 * period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
4160 * See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4161 * The callback can sleep.
4162 *
4163 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
4164 * synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
4165 * pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
4166 * the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
4167 * in @sta_state.
4168 * The callback can sleep.
4169 *
4170 * @link_sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can
4171 * be used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
4172 * from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
4173 * in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
4174 * uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
4175 * otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
4176 * Must be atomic.
4177 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
4178 * is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
4179 * the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
4180 *
4181 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
4182 * filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
4183 * let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
4184 * the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
4185 * all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
4186 * Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
4187 * The callback can sleep.
4188 *
4189 * @link_sta_statistics: Get link statistics for this station. For example with
4190 * beacon filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be
4191 * accurate, so let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can
4192 * fill most of the values (indicating which by setting the filled
4193 * bitmap), but not all of them make sense - see the source for which
4194 * ones are possible.
4195 * Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
4196 * The callback can sleep.
4197 *
4198 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
4199 * bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
4200 * Returns a negative error code on failure.
4201 * The callback can sleep.
4202 *
4203 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
4204 * this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
4205 * required function.
4206 * The callback can sleep.
4207 *
4208 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
4209 * Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
4210 * required function.
4211 * The callback can sleep.
4212 *
4213 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
4214 * firmware/hardware. Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
4215 * calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
4216 * as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
4217 * The callback can sleep.
4218 *
4219 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
4220 * with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
4221 * function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
4222 * TSF synchronization.
4223 * The callback can sleep.
4224 *
4225 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
4226 * This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
4227 * used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
4228 * Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
4229 * The callback can sleep.
4230 *
4231 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
4232 *
4233 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
4234 * need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
4235 * and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
4236 * The callback can sleep.
4237 *
4238 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
4239 * in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
4240 * accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
4241 * estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
4242 * coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
4243 *
4244 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
4245 * be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
4246 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
4247 *
4248 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
4249 * that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
4250 * of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
4251 * use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
4252 * If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
4253 * Note that vif can be NULL.
4254 * The callback can sleep.
4255 *
4256 * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
4257 * the given station, as it's about to be removed.
4258 * The callback can sleep.
4259 *
4260 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
4261 * switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
4262 * callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
4263 * completion of the channel switch.
4264 *
4265 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4266 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4267 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4268 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4269 *
4270 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4271 *
4272 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
4273 * call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
4274 * that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
4275 * offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
4276 * normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
4277 * duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
4278 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
4279 * Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
4280 * must be accepted in this case.
4281 * This callback may sleep.
4282 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
4283 * aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
4284 *
4285 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
4286 *
4287 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
4288 *
4289 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
4290 * queues before entering power save.
4291 *
4292 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
4293 * when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
4294 * The callback can sleep.
4295 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
4296 * &enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
4297 * The callback must be atomic.
4298 *
4299 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4300 * parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4301 * sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4302 * to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4303 * Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4304 * if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4305 * the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4306 * the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4307 * more-data bit must always be set.
4308 * The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4309 * from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4310 * In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4311 * @num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4312 * this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4313 * on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4314 * period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4315 * responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4316 * In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4317 * bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4318 * at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4319 * setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4320 * service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4321 * on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4322 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4323 * This callback must be atomic.
4324 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4325 * to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4326 * via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4327 * released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4328 * and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4329 * frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4330 * them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4331 * on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4332 * bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4333 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4334 * The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4335 * frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4336 * This callback must be atomic.
4337 *
4338 * @get_et_sset_count: Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4339 * Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4340 * expected to return a static value.
4341 *
4342 * @get_et_stats: Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4343 *
4344 * @get_et_strings: Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4345 * and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4346 * Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4347 * expected to return a static value.
4348 *
4349 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4350 * before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4351 * bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4352 * yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4353 * transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4354 * powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4355 * management frame prior to transmitting that frame to allow the driver
4356 * to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response and be
4357 * able to synchronize with the GO.
4358 * The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4359 * mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4360 * Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4361 * data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4362 * driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4363 * The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4364 * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4365 * transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4366 * is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4367 * Note that this isn't always called for each mgd_prepare_tx() call, for
4368 * example for SAE the 'confirm' messages can be on the air in any order.
4369 *
4370 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4371 * a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4372 * channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4373 * setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4374 * mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4375 * discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4376 * 2 * (DTIM period).
4377 * The callback is optional and can sleep.
4378 *
4379 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4380 * This callback may sleep.
4381 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4382 * This callback may sleep.
4383 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4384 * may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4385 * channel context with different settings
4386 * This callback may sleep.
4387 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4388 * to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4389 * This callback may sleep.
4390 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4391 * unbound from vif.
4392 * This callback may sleep.
4393 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4394 * another, as specified in the list of
4395 * @ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4396 * to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4397 * This callback may sleep.
4398 *
4399 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4400 * information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4401 * context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4402 * software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4403 * just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4404 * disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4405 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4406 *
4407 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4408 * during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4409 * This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4410 * indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4411 * This callback may sleep.
4412 *
4413 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4414 * Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4415 * This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4416 *
4417 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4418 * Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4419 * function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4420 * decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4421 * ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4422 * get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4423 * 1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4424 * transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4425 * If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4426 * since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4427 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4428 * before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4429 * gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4430 * the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4431 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4432 * after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4433 * driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4434 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4435 * when channel switch procedure was aborted, allowing the
4436 * driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4437 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4438 * when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4439 * CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4440 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4441 * information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4442 * channel context is bound before this is called.
4443 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4444 *
4445 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4446 * specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4447 * if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4448 *
4449 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4450 * and hardware limits.
4451 *
4452 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4453 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4454 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4455 * driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4456 * the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4457 * The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4458 * optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4459 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4460 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4461 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4462 * response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4463 * parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4464 * an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4465 * response template is provided, together with the location of the
4466 * switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4467 * the function call.
4468 *
4469 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4470 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4471 * synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4472 * pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4473 * currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4474 *
4475 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4476 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4477 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4478 * contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4479 * are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4480 * The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4481 * some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4482 * changed parameters.
4483 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4484 * cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4485 * this call.
4486 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4487 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4488 * NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4489 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4490 * aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4491 * between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4492 * skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4493 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4494 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4495 *
4496 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4497 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4498 * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4499 * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4500 * This callback may sleep.
4501 * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4502 * This callback may sleep.
4503 * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4504 * 4-address mode
4505 * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4506 * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4507 * to use rx decapsulation offload
4508 * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4509 * This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4510 * are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4511 * The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4512 * twt structure.
4513 * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4514 * from the peer.
4515 * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4516 * radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4517 * or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4518 * Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4519 * switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4520 * radar channel.
4521 * The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4522 * disable background CAC/radar detection.
4523 * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4524 * resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4525 * @can_activate_links: Checks if a specific active_links bitmap is
4526 * supported by the driver.
4527 * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4528 * removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4529 * but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4530 * new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4531 * The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4532 * that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4533 * Note that removal of link should always succeed, so the return value
4534 * will be ignored in a removal only case.
4535 * This callback can sleep.
4536 * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4537 * @change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4538 * Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4539 * i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4540 * In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4541 * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4542 * not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4543 * that.
4544 * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4545 * flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4546 * Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4547 * at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4548 * @can_neg_ttlm: for managed interface, requests the driver to determine
4549 * if the requested TID-To-Link mapping can be accepted or not.
4550 * If it's not accepted the driver may suggest a preferred mapping and
4551 * modify @ttlm parameter with the suggested TID-to-Link mapping.
4552 * @prep_add_interface: prepare for interface addition. This can be used by
4553 * drivers to prepare for the addition of a new interface, e.g., allocate
4554 * the needed resources etc. This callback doesn't guarantee that an
4555 * interface with the specified type would be added, and thus drivers that
4556 * implement this callback need to handle such cases. The type is the full
4557 * &enum nl80211_iftype.
4558 * @set_eml_op_mode: Configure eMLSR/eMLMR operation mode in the underlay
4559 * driver according to the parameter received in the EML Operating mode
4560 * notification frame.
4561 */
4562 struct ieee80211_ops {
4563 void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4564 struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4565 struct sk_buff *skb);
4566 int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4567 void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool suspend);
4568 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4569 int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4570 int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4571 void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4572 #endif
4573 int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4574 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4575 int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4576 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4577 enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4578 void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4579 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4580 int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx, u32 changed);
4581 void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4582 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4583 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4584 u64 changed);
4585 void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4586 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4587 u64 changed);
4588 void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4589 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4590 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4591 u64 changed);
4592
4593 int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4594 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4595 void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4596 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4597
4598 u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4599 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4600 void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4601 unsigned int changed_flags,
4602 unsigned int *total_flags,
4603 u64 multicast);
4604 void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4605 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4606 unsigned int filter_flags,
4607 unsigned int changed_flags);
4608 int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4609 bool set);
4610 int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4611 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4612 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4613 void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4614 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4615 struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4616 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4617 u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4618 void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4619 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4620 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4621 void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4622 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4623 int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4624 struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4625 void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4626 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4627 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4628 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4629 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4630 struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4631 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4632 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4633 void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4634 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4635 const u8 *mac_addr);
4636 void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4637 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4638 int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4639 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4640 void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4641 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4642 struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4643 int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4644 u32 value);
4645 int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4646 u32 value);
4647 int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4648 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4649 int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4650 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4651 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4652 void (*vif_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4653 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4654 void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4655 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4656 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4657 struct dentry *dir);
4658 void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4659 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4660 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4661 struct dentry *dir);
4662 void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4663 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4664 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4665 struct dentry *dir);
4666 #endif
4667 void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4668 enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4669 int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4670 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4671 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4672 int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4673 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4674 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4675 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4676 void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4677 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4678 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4679 void (*link_sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4680 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4681 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4682 u32 changed);
4683 void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4684 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4685 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4686 void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4687 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4688 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4689 struct station_info *sinfo);
4690 int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4691 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4692 unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4693 const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4694 u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4695 void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4696 u64 tsf);
4697 void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4698 s64 offset);
4699 void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4700 int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4701 void (*link_sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4702 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4703 struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4704 struct link_station_info *link_sinfo);
4705
4706 /**
4707 * @ampdu_action:
4708 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4709 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4710 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4711 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4712 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4713 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4714 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4715 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4716 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4717 *
4718 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4719 * - ``RX: 2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4720 * - ``TX: 8..1...``
4721 *
4722 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4723 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4724 *
4725 * - ``TX: 1 or``
4726 * - ``TX: 18 or``
4727 * - ``TX: 81``
4728 *
4729 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4730 *
4731 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4732 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4733 * if the session can start immediately.
4734 *
4735 * The callback can sleep.
4736 */
4737 int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4738 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4739 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4740 int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4741 struct survey_info *survey);
4742 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4743 void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4744 s16 coverage_class);
4745 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4746 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4747 void *data, int len);
4748 int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4749 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4750 void *data, int len);
4751 #endif
4752 void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4753 u32 queues, bool drop);
4754 void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4755 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4756 void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4757 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4758 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4759 int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4760 u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4761 int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4762 u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4763
4764 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4765 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4766 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4767 int duration,
4768 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4769 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4770 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4771 int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4772 void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4773 u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4774 bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4775 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4776 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4777 void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4778 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4779 const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4780
4781 void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4782 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4783 u16 tids, int num_frames,
4784 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4785 bool more_data);
4786 void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4787 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4788 u16 tids, int num_frames,
4789 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4790 bool more_data);
4791
4792 int (*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4793 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4794 void (*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4795 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4796 struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4797 void (*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4798 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4799 u32 sset, u8 *data);
4800
4801 void (*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4802 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4803 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4804 void (*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4805 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4806 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4807
4808 void (*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4809 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4810 unsigned int link_id);
4811
4812 int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4813 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4814 void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4815 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4816 void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4817 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4818 u32 changed);
4819 int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4820 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4821 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4822 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4823 void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4824 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4825 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4826 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4827 int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4828 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4829 int n_vifs,
4830 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4831
4832 void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4833 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4834
4835 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4836 void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4837 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4838 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4839 #endif
4840 void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4841 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4842 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4843 int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4844 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4845 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4846
4847 int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4848 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4849 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4850 void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4851 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4852 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4853 void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4854 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4855 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4856
4857 int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4858 void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4859 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4860 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4861 int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4862 unsigned int link_id, int *dbm);
4863
4864 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4865 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4866 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4867 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4868 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4869 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4870 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4871 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4872 void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4873 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4874 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4875
4876 void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4877 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4878 void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4879
4880 int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4881 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4882 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4883 int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4884 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4885 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4886 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4887 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4888 int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4889 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4890 const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4891 void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4892 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4893 u8 instance_id);
4894 bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4895 struct sk_buff *head,
4896 struct sk_buff *skb);
4897 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4898 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4899 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4900 int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4901 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4902 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4903 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4904 int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4905 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4906 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4907 struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4908 int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4909 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4910 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4911 void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4912 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4913 void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4914 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4915 int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4916 const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4917 void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4918 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4919 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4920 void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4921 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4922 struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4923 void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4924 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4925 int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4926 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4927 int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4928 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4929 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4930 struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4931 struct net_device_path *path);
4932 bool (*can_activate_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4933 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4934 u16 active_links);
4935 int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4936 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4937 u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4938 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4939 int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4940 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4941 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4942 u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4943 int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4944 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4945 struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4946 int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4947 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4948 struct net_device *dev,
4949 enum tc_setup_type type,
4950 void *type_data);
4951 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res
4952 (*can_neg_ttlm)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4953 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm *ttlm);
4954 void (*prep_add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4955 enum nl80211_iftype type);
4956 int (*set_eml_op_mode)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4957 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4958 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4959 struct ieee80211_eml_params *eml_params);
4960 };
4961
4962 /**
4963 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4964 *
4965 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4966 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4967 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4968 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4969 * @priv_data_len.
4970 *
4971 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4972 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4973 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4974 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4975 *
4976 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4977 */
4978 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4979 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4980 const char *requested_name);
4981
4982 /**
4983 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4984 *
4985 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4986 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4987 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4988 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4989 * @priv_data_len.
4990 *
4991 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4992 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4993 *
4994 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4995 */
4996 static inline
ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,const struct ieee80211_ops * ops)4997 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4998 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4999 {
5000 return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
5001 }
5002
5003 /**
5004 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
5005 *
5006 * You must call this function before any other functions in
5007 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
5008 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
5009 *
5010 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5011 *
5012 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
5013 */
5014 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5015
5016 /**
5017 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
5018 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
5019 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
5020 * (full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
5021 */
5022 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
5023 int throughput;
5024 int blink_time;
5025 };
5026
5027 /**
5028 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
5029 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
5030 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
5031 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
5032 * interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
5033 */
5034 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
5035 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO = BIT(0),
5036 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK = BIT(1),
5037 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED = BIT(2),
5038 };
5039
5040 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5041 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5042 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5043 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5044 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5045 const char *
5046 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5047 unsigned int flags,
5048 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
5049 unsigned int blink_table_len);
5050 #endif
5051 /**
5052 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
5053 *
5054 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5055 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5056 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5057 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5058 *
5059 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5060 *
5061 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5062 */
ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5063 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5064 {
5065 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5066 return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
5067 #else
5068 return NULL;
5069 #endif
5070 }
5071
5072 /**
5073 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
5074 *
5075 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5076 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5077 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5078 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5079 *
5080 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5081 *
5082 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5083 */
ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5084 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5085 {
5086 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5087 return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
5088 #else
5089 return NULL;
5090 #endif
5091 }
5092
5093 /**
5094 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
5095 *
5096 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5097 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5098 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5099 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5100 *
5101 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5102 *
5103 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5104 */
ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5105 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5106 {
5107 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5108 return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
5109 #else
5110 return NULL;
5111 #endif
5112 }
5113
5114 /**
5115 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
5116 *
5117 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5118 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5119 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5120 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5121 *
5122 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5123 *
5124 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5125 */
ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)5126 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5127 {
5128 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5129 return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
5130 #else
5131 return NULL;
5132 #endif
5133 }
5134
5135 /**
5136 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
5137 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
5138 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
5139 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
5140 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
5141 *
5142 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
5143 * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
5144 *
5145 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
5146 */
5147 static inline const char *
ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,unsigned int flags,const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink * blink_table,unsigned int blink_table_len)5148 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
5149 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
5150 unsigned int blink_table_len)
5151 {
5152 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5153 return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
5154 blink_table_len);
5155 #else
5156 return NULL;
5157 #endif
5158 }
5159
5160 /**
5161 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
5162 *
5163 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
5164 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
5165 *
5166 * @hw: the hardware to unregister
5167 */
5168 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5169
5170 /**
5171 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
5172 *
5173 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
5174 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
5175 * before calling this function.
5176 *
5177 * @hw: the hardware to free
5178 */
5179 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5180
5181 /**
5182 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
5183 *
5184 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
5185 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
5186 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
5187 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
5188 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
5189 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
5190 *
5191 * @hw: the hardware to restart
5192 */
5193 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5194
5195 /**
5196 * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
5197 *
5198 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5199 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5200 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5201 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5202 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5203 *
5204 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5205 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5206 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5207 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5208 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5209 *
5210 * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
5211 *
5212 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5213 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5214 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5215 * @list: the destination list
5216 */
5217 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5218 struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
5219
5220 /**
5221 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
5222 *
5223 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5224 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5225 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5226 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5227 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5228 *
5229 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5230 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5231 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5232 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5233 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5234 *
5235 * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
5236 *
5237 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5238 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5239 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5240 * @napi: the NAPI context
5241 */
5242 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5243 struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
5244
5245 /**
5246 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
5247 *
5248 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5249 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5250 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5251 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5252 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5253 *
5254 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5255 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5256 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5257 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5258 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5259 *
5260 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
5261 *
5262 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5263 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5264 */
ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5265 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
5266 {
5267 ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
5268 }
5269
5270 /**
5271 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
5272 *
5273 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
5274 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5275 *
5276 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
5277 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
5278 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5279 *
5280 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5281 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5282 */
5283 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
5284
5285 /**
5286 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
5287 *
5288 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
5289 * (internally disables bottom halves).
5290 *
5291 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
5292 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5293 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5294 *
5295 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5296 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5297 */
ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5298 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5299 struct sk_buff *skb)
5300 {
5301 local_bh_disable();
5302 ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
5303 local_bh_enable();
5304 }
5305
5306 /**
5307 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
5308 *
5309 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
5310 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
5311 * entering/leaving PS mode.
5312 *
5313 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
5314 *
5315 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
5316 * each other.
5317 *
5318 * @sta: currently connected sta
5319 * @start: start or stop PS
5320 *
5321 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
5322 */
5323 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
5324
5325 /**
5326 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
5327 * (in process context)
5328 *
5329 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
5330 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
5331 * applies.
5332 *
5333 * @sta: currently connected sta
5334 * @start: start or stop PS
5335 *
5336 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
5337 */
ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,bool start)5338 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5339 bool start)
5340 {
5341 int ret;
5342
5343 local_bh_disable();
5344 ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5345 local_bh_enable();
5346
5347 return ret;
5348 }
5349
5350 /**
5351 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5352 * @sta: currently connected station
5353 *
5354 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5355 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5356 * connected station was received.
5357 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5358 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5359 * be serialized.
5360 */
5361 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5362
5363 /**
5364 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5365 * @sta: currently connected station
5366 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5367 *
5368 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5369 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5370 * from a connected station was received.
5371 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5372 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5373 * serialized.
5374 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5375 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5376 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5377 * checks.
5378 */
5379 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5380
5381 /*
5382 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5383 * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5384 */
5385 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM ALIGN(14, 4)
5386
5387 /**
5388 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5389 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5390 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5391 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5392 *
5393 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5394 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5395 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5396 *
5397 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5398 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5399 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5400 * call! Beware of the locking!)
5401 *
5402 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5403 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5404 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5405 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5406 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5407 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5408 *
5409 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5410 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5411 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5412 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5413 * use this API.
5414 */
5415 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5416 u8 tid, bool buffered);
5417
5418 /**
5419 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5420 *
5421 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5422 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5423 * rate selection table for the station entry.
5424 *
5425 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5426 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5427 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5428 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5429 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5430 */
5431 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5432 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5433 struct sk_buff *skb,
5434 struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5435 int max_rates);
5436
5437 /**
5438 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5439 *
5440 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5441 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5442 * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5443 *
5444 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5445 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5446 * @info: tx status information
5447 */
5448 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5449 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5450 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5451
5452 /**
5453 * ieee80211_tx_status_skb - transmit status callback
5454 *
5455 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5456 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5457 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5458 *
5459 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5460 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5461 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5462 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5463 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5464 *
5465 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5466 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5467 */
5468 void ieee80211_tx_status_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5469 struct sk_buff *skb);
5470
5471 /**
5472 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5473 *
5474 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5475 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5476 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5477 *
5478 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5479 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5480 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5481 *
5482 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5483 * @status: tx status information
5484 */
5485 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5486 struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5487
5488 /**
5489 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5490 *
5491 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5492 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5493 * specific skbs.
5494 *
5495 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5496 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5497 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5498 *
5499 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5500 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5501 * (NULL for multicast packets)
5502 * @info: tx status information
5503 */
ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_sta * sta,struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)5504 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5505 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5506 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5507 {
5508 struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5509 .sta = sta,
5510 .info = info,
5511 };
5512
5513 ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5514 }
5515
5516 /**
5517 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5518 *
5519 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in process context.
5520 *
5521 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5522 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5523 * for a single hardware.
5524 *
5525 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5526 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5527 */
ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)5528 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5529 struct sk_buff *skb)
5530 {
5531 local_bh_disable();
5532 ieee80211_tx_status_skb(hw, skb);
5533 local_bh_enable();
5534 }
5535
5536 /**
5537 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5538 *
5539 * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in IRQ context
5540 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5541 *
5542 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5543 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5544 *
5545 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5546 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5547 */
5548 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5549 struct sk_buff *skb);
5550
5551 /**
5552 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5553 *
5554 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5555 * connected STA.
5556 *
5557 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5558 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5559 */
5560 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5561
5562 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5563
5564 /**
5565 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5566 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5567 * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5568 * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5569 * to countdown counters. This array can contain zero values which
5570 * should be ignored.
5571 * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5572 */
5573 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5574 u16 tim_offset;
5575 u16 tim_length;
5576
5577 u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5578 u16 mbssid_off;
5579 };
5580
5581 /**
5582 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5583 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5584 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5585 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5586 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5587 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5588 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5589 *
5590 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5591 * obtain the beacon template.
5592 *
5593 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5594 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5595 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5596 * applicable, the CSA count.
5597 *
5598 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5599 *
5600 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5601 */
5602 struct sk_buff *
5603 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5604 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5605 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5606 unsigned int link_id);
5607
5608 /**
5609 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5610 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5611 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5612 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5613 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5614 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5615 * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5616 *
5617 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5618 * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5619 * requested index.
5620 *
5621 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5622 */
5623 struct sk_buff *
5624 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5625 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5626 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5627 unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5628
5629 /**
5630 * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5631 * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5632 *
5633 * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5634 * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5635 * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5636 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5637 */
5638 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5639 u8 cnt;
5640 struct {
5641 struct sk_buff *skb;
5642 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5643 } bcn[];
5644 };
5645
5646 /**
5647 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5648 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5649 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5650 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5651 *
5652 * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5653 * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5654 * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5655 * one multiple BSSID element.
5656 *
5657 * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5658 *
5659 * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5660 * %NULL on error.
5661 */
5662 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5663 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5664 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5665 unsigned int link_id);
5666
5667 /**
5668 * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5669 * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5670 *
5671 * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5672 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5673 */
5674 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5675
5676 /**
5677 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5678 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5679 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5680 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5681 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5682 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5683 * (including the ID and length bytes!).
5684 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5685 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5686 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5687 *
5688 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5689 * obtain the beacon frame.
5690 *
5691 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5692 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5693 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5694 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5695 *
5696 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5697 *
5698 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5699 */
5700 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5701 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5702 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5703 unsigned int link_id);
5704
5705 /**
5706 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5707 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5708 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5709 * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5710 * that is not associated with AP MLD).
5711 *
5712 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5713 *
5714 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5715 */
ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_vif * vif,unsigned int link_id)5716 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5717 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5718 unsigned int link_id)
5719 {
5720 return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5721 }
5722
5723 /**
5724 * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5725 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5726 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5727 *
5728 * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5729 * This function is called implicitly when
5730 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5731 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5732 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5733 *
5734 * Return: new countdown value
5735 */
5736 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5737 unsigned int link_id);
5738
5739 /**
5740 * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5741 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5742 * @counter: the new value for the counter
5743 *
5744 * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5745 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5746 *
5747 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5748 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5749 */
5750 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5751
5752 /**
5753 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5754 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5755 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5756 *
5757 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5758 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5759 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5760 */
5761 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id);
5762
5763 /**
5764 * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5765 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5766 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5767 *
5768 * Return: %true if the countdown reached 1, %false otherwise
5769 */
5770 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5771 unsigned int link_id);
5772
5773 /**
5774 * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5775 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5776 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5777 *
5778 * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5779 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5780 * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5781 */
5782 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 link_id);
5783
5784 /**
5785 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5786 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5787 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5788 *
5789 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5790 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5791 *
5792 * Can only be called in AP mode.
5793 *
5794 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5795 */
5796 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5797 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5798
5799 /**
5800 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5801 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5802 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5803 *
5804 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5805 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5806 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5807 *
5808 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5809 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5810 *
5811 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5812 */
5813 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5814 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5815
5816 /**
5817 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5818 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5819 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5820 * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5821 * for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5822 * MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5823 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5824 * if at all possible
5825 *
5826 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5827 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5828 * BSSID and address is used.
5829 *
5830 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5831 * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5832 *
5833 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5834 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5835 *
5836 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5837 */
5838 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5839 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5840 int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5841
5842 /**
5843 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5844 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5845 * @src_addr: source MAC address
5846 * @ssid: SSID buffer
5847 * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5848 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5849 *
5850 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5851 * hardware.
5852 *
5853 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5854 */
5855 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5856 const u8 *src_addr,
5857 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5858 size_t tailroom);
5859
5860 /**
5861 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5862 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5863 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5864 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5865 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5866 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5867 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5868 *
5869 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5870 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5871 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5872 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5873 */
5874 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5875 const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5876 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5877 struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5878
5879 /**
5880 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5881 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5882 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5883 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5884 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5885 *
5886 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5887 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5888 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5889 *
5890 * Return: The duration.
5891 */
5892 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5893 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5894 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5895
5896 /**
5897 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5898 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5899 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5900 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5901 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5902 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5903 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5904 *
5905 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5906 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5907 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5908 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5909 */
5910 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5911 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5912 const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5913 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5914 struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5915
5916 /**
5917 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5918 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5919 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5920 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5921 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5922 *
5923 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5924 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5925 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5926 *
5927 * Return: The duration.
5928 */
5929 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5930 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5931 size_t frame_len,
5932 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5933
5934 /**
5935 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5936 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5937 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5938 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5939 * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5940 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5941 *
5942 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5943 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5944 *
5945 * Return: The duration.
5946 */
5947 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5948 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5949 enum nl80211_band band,
5950 size_t frame_len,
5951 struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5952
5953 /**
5954 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5955 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5956 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5957 *
5958 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5959 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5960 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5961 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5962 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5963 *
5964 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5965 * frames are available.
5966 *
5967 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5968 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5969 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5970 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5971 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5972 * use common code for all beacons.
5973 */
5974 struct sk_buff *
5975 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5976
5977 /**
5978 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5979 *
5980 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5981 *
5982 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5983 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5984 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5985 */
5986 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5987 u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5988
5989 /**
5990 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5991 *
5992 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5993 * from the given packet.
5994 *
5995 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5996 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5997 * with this P1K
5998 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5999 */
ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf * keyconf,struct sk_buff * skb,u16 * p1k)6000 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6001 struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
6002 {
6003 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
6004 const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
6005 u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
6006
6007 ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
6008 }
6009
6010 /**
6011 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
6012 *
6013 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
6014 * and transmitter address.
6015 *
6016 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6017 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
6018 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
6019 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
6020 */
6021 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6022 const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
6023
6024 /**
6025 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
6026 *
6027 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
6028 * in the packet.
6029 *
6030 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6031 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
6032 * encrypted with this key
6033 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
6034 */
6035 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6036 struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
6037
6038 /**
6039 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
6040 *
6041 * @pos: start of crypto header
6042 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6043 * @pn: PN to add
6044 *
6045 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
6046 * the packet payload)
6047 *
6048 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
6049 * point to the crypto header)
6050 */
6051 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
6052
6053 /**
6054 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
6055 *
6056 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6057 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
6058 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
6059 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
6060 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
6061 *
6062 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
6063 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
6064 * by the device and not by mac80211.
6065 *
6066 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
6067 * can be done concurrently.
6068 */
6069 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6070 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
6071
6072 /**
6073 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
6074 *
6075 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6076 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
6077 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
6078 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
6079 * @seq: new sequence data
6080 *
6081 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
6082 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
6083 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
6084 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
6085 *
6086 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
6087 * can be done concurrently.
6088 */
6089 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6090 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
6091
6092 /**
6093 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
6094 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
6095 * @idx: the keyidx of the key
6096 * @key_data: the key data
6097 * @key_len: the key data. Might be bigger than the actual key length,
6098 * but not smaller (for the driver convinence)
6099 * @link_id: the link id of the key or -1 for non-MLO
6100 *
6101 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
6102 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
6103 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
6104 *
6105 * Return: the newly allocated key structure, which will have
6106 * similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
6107 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
6108 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
6109 *
6110 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
6111 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
6112 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
6113 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
6114 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
6115 * of the reconfiguration.
6116 *
6117 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
6118 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
6119 *
6120 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
6121 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call.
6122 */
6123 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
6124 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6125 u8 idx, u8 *key_data, u8 key_len,
6126 int link_id);
6127
6128 /**
6129 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
6130 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
6131 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
6132 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
6133 * @gfp: allocation flags
6134 */
6135 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
6136 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
6137
6138 /**
6139 * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
6140 *
6141 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6142 * at the same time.
6143 *
6144 * @keyconf: the key in question
6145 */
6146 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6147
6148 /**
6149 * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
6150 *
6151 * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6152 * at the same time.
6153 *
6154 * @keyconf: the key in question
6155 */
6156 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6157
6158 /**
6159 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
6160 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6161 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6162 *
6163 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
6164 */
6165 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6166
6167 /**
6168 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
6169 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6170 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6171 *
6172 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
6173 */
6174 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6175
6176 /**
6177 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
6178 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6179 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6180 *
6181 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
6182 *
6183 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
6184 */
6185
6186 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6187
6188 /**
6189 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
6190 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6191 *
6192 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
6193 */
6194 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6195
6196 /**
6197 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
6198 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6199 *
6200 * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
6201 */
6202 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6203
6204 /**
6205 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
6206 *
6207 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
6208 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
6209 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
6210 * any context, including hardirq context.
6211 *
6212 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
6213 * @info: information about the completed scan
6214 */
6215 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6216 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6217
6218 /**
6219 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
6220 *
6221 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
6222 * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
6223 *
6224 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6225 */
6226 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6227
6228 /**
6229 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
6230 *
6231 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
6232 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
6233 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
6234 * while associating, for instance.
6235 *
6236 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6237 */
6238 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6239
6240 /**
6241 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
6242 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
6243 * been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
6244 * reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
6245 * interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
6246 * haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6247 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
6248 * interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6249 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
6250 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
6251 * is not in the driver. This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
6252 * for instance.
6253 */
6254 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
6255 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL = 0,
6256 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL = BIT(0),
6257 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE = BIT(1),
6258 IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER = BIT(2),
6259 };
6260
6261 /**
6262 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
6263 *
6264 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6265 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
6266 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
6267 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6268 *
6269 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6270 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6271 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6272 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6273 */
6274 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6275 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6276 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6277 void *data);
6278
6279 /**
6280 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
6281 *
6282 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6283 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6284 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
6285 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
6286 * be used.
6287 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6288 *
6289 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6290 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6291 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6292 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6293 */
6294 static inline void
ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u32 iter_flags,void (* iterator)(void * data,u8 * mac,struct ieee80211_vif * vif),void * data)6295 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6296 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6297 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6298 void *data)
6299 {
6300 ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
6301 iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
6302 iterator, data);
6303 }
6304
6305 /**
6306 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
6307 *
6308 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6309 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6310 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6311 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
6312 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6313 *
6314 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6315 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6316 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6317 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6318 */
6319 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6320 u32 iter_flags,
6321 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6322 u8 *mac,
6323 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6324 void *data);
6325
6326 struct ieee80211_vif *
6327 __ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6328 struct ieee80211_vif *prev,
6329 u32 iter_flags);
6330
6331 /**
6332 * for_each_interface - iterate interfaces under wiphy mutex
6333 * @vif: the iterator variable
6334 * @hw: the HW to iterate for
6335 * @flags: the iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6336 */
6337 #define for_each_interface(vif, hw, flags) \
6338 for (vif = __ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw, NULL, flags); \
6339 vif; \
6340 vif = __ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw, vif, flags))
6341
6342 /**
6343 * for_each_active_interface - iterate active interfaces under wiphy mutex
6344 * @vif: the iterator variable
6345 * @hw: the HW to iterate for
6346 */
6347 #define for_each_active_interface(vif, hw) \
6348 for_each_interface(vif, hw, IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE)
6349
6350 /**
6351 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6352 *
6353 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6354 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6355 * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
6356 *
6357 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6358 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6359 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6360 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6361 */
6362 static inline void
ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u32 iter_flags,void (* iterator)(void * data,u8 * mac,struct ieee80211_vif * vif),void * data)6363 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6364 u32 iter_flags,
6365 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6366 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6367 void *data)
6368 {
6369 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
6370
6371 for_each_interface(vif, hw, iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE)
6372 iterator(data, vif->addr, vif);
6373 }
6374
6375 /**
6376 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6377 *
6378 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6379 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6380 * function for them.
6381 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6382 *
6383 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6384 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6385 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6386 */
6387 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6388 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6389 struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6390 void *data);
6391
6392 struct ieee80211_sta *
6393 __ieee80211_iterate_stations(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6394 struct ieee80211_sta *prev);
6395
6396 /**
6397 * for_each_station - iterate stations under wiphy mutex
6398 * @sta: the iterator variable
6399 * @hw: the HW to iterate for
6400 */
6401 #define for_each_station(sta, hw) \
6402 for (sta = __ieee80211_iterate_stations(hw, NULL); \
6403 sta; \
6404 sta = __ieee80211_iterate_stations(hw, sta))
6405
6406 /**
6407 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx - iterate stations
6408 *
6409 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6410 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6411 * function for them. This version can only be used while holding the wiphy
6412 * mutex.
6413 *
6414 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6415 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6416 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6417 */
6418 static inline void
ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,void (* iterator)(void * data,struct ieee80211_sta * sta),void * data)6419 ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6420 void (*iterator)(void *data,
6421 struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6422 void *data)
6423 {
6424 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
6425
6426 for_each_station(sta, hw)
6427 iterator(data, sta);
6428 }
6429
6430 /**
6431 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6432 *
6433 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6434 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6435 *
6436 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6437 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6438 */
6439 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6440
6441 /**
6442 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6443 *
6444 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6445 * workqueue.
6446 *
6447 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6448 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6449 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6450 */
6451 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6452 struct delayed_work *dwork,
6453 unsigned long delay);
6454
6455 /**
6456 * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6457 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6458 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6459 *
6460 * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6461 * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6462 * mac80211.
6463 *
6464 * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6465 */
6466 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6467 u16 tid);
6468
6469 /**
6470 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6471 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6472 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6473 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6474 *
6475 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6476 *
6477 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6478 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6479 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6480 */
6481 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6482 u16 timeout);
6483
6484 /**
6485 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6486 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6487 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6488 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6489 *
6490 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6491 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6492 * from any context.
6493 */
6494 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6495 u16 tid);
6496
6497 /**
6498 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6499 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6500 * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6501 *
6502 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6503 *
6504 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6505 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6506 * will be managed by the mac80211.
6507 */
6508 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6509
6510 /**
6511 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6512 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6513 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6514 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6515 *
6516 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6517 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6518 * can be called from any context.
6519 */
6520 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6521 u16 tid);
6522
6523 /**
6524 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6525 *
6526 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6527 * @addr: station's address
6528 *
6529 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6530 *
6531 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6532 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6533 */
6534 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6535 const u8 *addr);
6536
6537 /**
6538 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6539 *
6540 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6541 * @addr: remote station's address
6542 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6543 *
6544 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6545 *
6546 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6547 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6548 *
6549 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6550 * the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6551 * We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6552 * logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6553 * BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6554 * In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6555 * is not reliable.
6556 *
6557 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6558 */
6559 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6560 const u8 *addr,
6561 const u8 *localaddr);
6562
6563 /**
6564 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6565 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6566 * @addr: remote station's link address
6567 * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6568 * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6569 * may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6570 *
6571 * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6572 *
6573 * Return: pointer to STA if found, otherwise %NULL.
6574 */
6575 struct ieee80211_sta *
6576 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6577 const u8 *addr,
6578 const u8 *localaddr,
6579 unsigned int *link_id);
6580
6581 /**
6582 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6583 * @hw: the hardware
6584 * @pubsta: the station
6585 * @block: whether to block or unblock
6586 *
6587 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6588 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6589 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6590 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6591 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6592 *
6593 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6594 * manner.
6595 *
6596 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6597 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6598 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6599 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6600 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6601 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6602 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6603 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6604 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6605 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6606 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6607 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6608 * woke up while blocked or not.
6609 */
6610 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6611 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6612
6613 /**
6614 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6615 * @pubsta: the station
6616 *
6617 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6618 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6619 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6620 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6621 *
6622 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6623 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6624 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6625 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6626 *
6627 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6628 * driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6629 * you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6630 * and restore the _irqsafe version!
6631 */
6632 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6633
6634 /**
6635 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6636 * @pubsta: the station
6637 * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6638 *
6639 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6640 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6641 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6642 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6643 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6644 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6645 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6646 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6647 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6648 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6649 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6650 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6651 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6652 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6653 */
6654 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6655
6656 /**
6657 * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6658 * @pubsta: the station
6659 *
6660 * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6661 * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6662 * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6663 *
6664 * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6665 * there is no need to call this function.
6666 */
6667 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6668
6669 /**
6670 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6671 *
6672 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6673 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6674 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6675 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6676 *
6677 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6678 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6679 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6680 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6681 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6682 * attempts.
6683 *
6684 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6685 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6686 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6687 * them to 0.
6688 *
6689 * @pubsta: the station
6690 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6691 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6692 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6693 */
6694 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6695 u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6696
6697 /**
6698 * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6699 *
6700 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6701 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6702 *
6703 * Return: %true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6704 * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return %false.
6705 */
6706 bool
6707 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6708
6709 /**
6710 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6711 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6712 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6713 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6714 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6715 *
6716 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; can sleep.
6717 *
6718 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6719 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6720 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6721 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend.
6722 *
6723 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6724 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6725 * set_key callback.
6726 */
6727 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6728 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6729 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6730 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6731 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6732 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6733 void *data),
6734 void *iter_data);
6735
6736 /**
6737 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6738 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6739 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6740 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6741 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6742 *
6743 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6744 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6745 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6746 * in removal process will be skipped.
6747 *
6748 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6749 * and thus iter must be atomic.
6750 */
6751 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6752 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6753 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6754 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6755 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6756 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6757 void *data),
6758 void *iter_data);
6759
6760 /**
6761 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6762 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6763 * @iter: iterator function
6764 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6765 *
6766 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6767 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6768 * places while calling into the driver.
6769 *
6770 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6771 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6772 * removed.
6773 *
6774 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6775 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6776 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6777 * or not.
6778 */
6779 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6780 struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6781 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6782 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6783 void *data),
6784 void *iter_data);
6785
6786 /**
6787 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_mtx - iterate channel contexts
6788 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6789 * @iter: iterator function
6790 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6791 *
6792 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function can only be used while
6793 * holding the wiphy mutex.
6794 *
6795 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6796 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6797 * removed.
6798 *
6799 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6800 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6801 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6802 * or not.
6803 */
6804 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_mtx(
6805 struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6806 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6807 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6808 void *data),
6809 void *iter_data);
6810
6811 /**
6812 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6813 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6814 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6815 *
6816 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6817 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6818 * information. This function must only be called from within the
6819 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6820 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6821 * %NULL.
6822 *
6823 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6824 */
6825 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6826 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6827
6828 /**
6829 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6830 *
6831 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6832 *
6833 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6834 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6835 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6836 */
6837 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6838
6839 /**
6840 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6841 *
6842 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6843 *
6844 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6845 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6846 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6847 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6848 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6849 *
6850 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6851 * without connection recovery attempts.
6852 */
6853 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6854
6855 /**
6856 * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6857 *
6858 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6859 * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6860 *
6861 * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6862 * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6863 */
6864 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6865
6866 /**
6867 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6868 *
6869 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6870 *
6871 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6872 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6873 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6874 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6875 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6876 *
6877 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6878 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6879 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6880 * disconnect normally later.
6881 *
6882 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6883 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6884 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6885 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6886 */
6887 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6888
6889 /**
6890 * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6891 * hardware restart
6892 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6893 *
6894 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6895 * hardware restart.
6896 */
6897 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6898
6899 /**
6900 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6901 * rssi threshold triggered
6902 *
6903 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6904 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6905 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6906 * @gfp: context flags
6907 *
6908 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6909 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6910 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6911 */
6912 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6913 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6914 s32 rssi_level,
6915 gfp_t gfp);
6916
6917 /**
6918 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6919 *
6920 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6921 * @gfp: context flags
6922 */
6923 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6924
6925 /**
6926 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6927 *
6928 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6929 * @chanctx_conf: Channel context on which radar is detected. Mandatory to
6930 * pass a valid pointer during MLO. For non-MLO %NULL can be passed
6931 */
6932 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6933 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf);
6934
6935 /**
6936 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6937 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6938 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6939 * @link_id: the link_id on which the switch was done. Ignored if success is
6940 * false.
6941 *
6942 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6943 * and wake up the suspended queues.
6944 */
6945 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success,
6946 unsigned int link_id);
6947
6948 /**
6949 * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6950 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6951 *
6952 * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6953 * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6954 * a deauth frame in this case.
6955 */
6956 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6957
6958 /**
6959 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6960 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6961 * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6962 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6963 *
6964 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6965 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6966 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6967 */
6968 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6969 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6970
6971 /**
6972 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6973 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6974 */
6975 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6976
6977 /**
6978 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6979 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6980 */
6981 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6982
6983 /**
6984 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6985 *
6986 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6987 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6988 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6989 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6990 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6991 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6992 *
6993 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6994 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6995 * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6996 */
6997 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6998 const u8 *addr);
6999
7000 /**
7001 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
7002 * @pubsta: station struct
7003 * @tid: the session's TID
7004 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
7005 * assumed to be out of the window after the call
7006 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
7007 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
7008 *
7009 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
7010 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
7011 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
7012 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
7013 * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames)
7014 */
7015 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
7016 u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
7017 u16 received_mpdus);
7018
7019 /**
7020 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
7021 *
7022 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
7023 * buffer.
7024 *
7025 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7026 * @ra: the peer's destination address
7027 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
7028 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
7029 */
7030 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
7031
7032 /**
7033 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
7034 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
7035 * @addr: station mac address
7036 * @tid: the rx tid
7037 */
7038 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
7039 unsigned int tid);
7040
7041 /**
7042 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
7043 *
7044 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
7045 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
7046 * reordering.
7047 *
7048 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
7049 * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
7050 *
7051 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
7052 * @addr: station mac address
7053 * @tid: the rx tid
7054 */
ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)7055 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7056 const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
7057 {
7058 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
7059 return;
7060 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
7061 }
7062
7063 /**
7064 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
7065 *
7066 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
7067 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
7068 * reordering.
7069 *
7070 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
7071 * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
7072 *
7073 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
7074 * @addr: station mac address
7075 * @tid: the rx tid
7076 */
ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)7077 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7078 const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
7079 {
7080 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
7081 return;
7082 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
7083 }
7084
7085 /**
7086 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
7087 *
7088 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
7089 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
7090 *
7091 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
7092 *
7093 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
7094 * @addr: station mac address
7095 * @tid: the rx tid
7096 */
7097 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7098 const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
7099
7100 /* Rate control API */
7101
7102 /**
7103 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
7104 *
7105 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
7106 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
7107 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
7108 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
7109 * to be filled in
7110 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
7111 * which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
7112 * used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
7113 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
7114 * RTS threshold
7115 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
7116 * if the selected rate supports it
7117 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
7118 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
7119 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
7120 */
7121 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
7122 struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
7123 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
7124 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
7125 struct sk_buff *skb;
7126 struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
7127 bool rts, short_preamble;
7128 u32 rate_idx_mask;
7129 u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
7130 bool bss;
7131 };
7132
7133 /**
7134 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
7135 */
7136 enum rate_control_capabilities {
7137 /**
7138 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
7139 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
7140 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
7141 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
7142 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
7143 */
7144 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
7145 /**
7146 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
7147 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
7148 */
7149 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
7150 };
7151
7152 struct rate_control_ops {
7153 unsigned long capa;
7154 const char *name;
7155 void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
7156 void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
7157 struct dentry *debugfsdir);
7158 void (*free)(void *priv);
7159
7160 void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
7161 void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7162 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7163 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
7164 void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7165 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7166 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7167 u32 changed);
7168 void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7169 void *priv_sta);
7170
7171 void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
7172 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7173 void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
7174 void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7175 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7176 struct sk_buff *skb);
7177 void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7178 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
7179
7180 void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
7181 struct dentry *dir);
7182
7183 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
7184 };
7185
rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,enum nl80211_band band,int index)7186 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7187 enum nl80211_band band,
7188 int index)
7189 {
7190 return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
7191 }
7192
7193 static inline s8
rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)7194 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7195 struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7196 {
7197 int i;
7198
7199 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7200 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7201 return i;
7202
7203 /* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
7204 WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
7205
7206 /* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
7207 return 0;
7208 }
7209
7210 static inline
rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)7211 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7212 struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7213 {
7214 unsigned int i;
7215
7216 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7217 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7218 return true;
7219 return false;
7220 }
7221
7222 /**
7223 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
7224 *
7225 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
7226 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
7227 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
7228 * the most recent rate control module decision.
7229 *
7230 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7231 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
7232 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
7233 *
7234 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7235 */
7236 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7237 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
7238 struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
7239
7240 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7241 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7242
7243 static inline bool
conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7244 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7245 {
7246 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
7247 }
7248
7249 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7250 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7251 {
7252 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7253 conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7254 }
7255
7256 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7257 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7258 {
7259 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7260 conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7261 }
7262
7263 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7264 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7265 {
7266 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
7267 }
7268
7269 static inline bool
conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)7270 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7271 {
7272 return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
7273 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
7274 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
7275 }
7276
7277 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type,bool p2p)7278 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
7279 {
7280 if (p2p) {
7281 switch (type) {
7282 case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
7283 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
7284 case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
7285 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
7286 default:
7287 break;
7288 }
7289 }
7290 return type;
7291 }
7292
7293 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7294 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7295 {
7296 return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
7297 }
7298
7299 /**
7300 * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
7301 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7302 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7303 *
7304 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
7305 */
7306 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7307 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7308 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7309 {
7310 return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7311 }
7312
7313 /**
7314 * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
7315 * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
7316 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7317 *
7318 * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
7319 */
7320 static inline __le16
ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7321 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7322 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7323 {
7324 return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7325 }
7326
7327 /**
7328 * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return EHT capabilities for sband/vif
7329 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7330 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7331 *
7332 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
7333 */
7334 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7335 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7336 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7337 {
7338 return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7339 }
7340
7341 /**
7342 * ieee80211_get_uhr_iftype_cap_vif - return UHR capabilities for sband/vif
7343 * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7344 * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7345 *
7346 * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_uhr_cap, or %NULL is none found
7347 */
7348 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_uhr_cap *
ieee80211_get_uhr_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)7349 ieee80211_get_uhr_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7350 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7351 {
7352 return ieee80211_get_uhr_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7353 }
7354
7355 /**
7356 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
7357 *
7358 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7359 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
7360 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
7361 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
7362 *
7363 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
7364 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
7365 * matching GroupId management frame.
7366 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
7367 */
7368 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
7369 const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
7370
7371 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7372 int rssi_min_thold,
7373 int rssi_max_thold);
7374
7375 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7376
7377 /**
7378 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
7379 *
7380 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7381 * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO
7382 *
7383 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
7384 *
7385 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
7386 * applicable.
7387 */
7388 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int link_id);
7389
7390 /**
7391 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
7392 * @vif: virtual interface
7393 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
7394 * @gfp: allocation flags
7395 *
7396 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
7397 */
7398 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7399 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7400 gfp_t gfp);
7401
7402 /**
7403 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
7404 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7405 * @vif: virtual interface
7406 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
7407 * @band: the band to transmit on
7408 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
7409 *
7410 * Return: %true if the skb was prepared, %false otherwise.
7411 * On failure, the skb is freed by this function; callers must not
7412 * free it again.
7413 *
7414 * Note: must be called under RCU lock
7415 */
7416 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7417 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
7418 int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
7419
7420 /**
7421 * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
7422 * of injected frames.
7423 *
7424 * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
7425 * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
7426 * of the skb before calling this function.
7427 *
7428 * @skb: packet injected by userspace
7429 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
7430 *
7431 * Return: %true if the radiotap header was parsed, %false otherwise
7432 */
7433 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
7434 struct net_device *dev);
7435
7436 /**
7437 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
7438 *
7439 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
7440 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
7441 *
7442 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
7443 *
7444 * private:
7445 *
7446 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
7447 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
7448 */
7449 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
7450 u32 next_tsf;
7451 bool has_next_tsf;
7452
7453 u8 absent;
7454
7455 u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7456 struct {
7457 u32 start;
7458 u32 duration;
7459 u32 interval;
7460 } desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7461 };
7462
7463 /**
7464 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
7465 *
7466 * @attr: P2P NoA IE
7467 * @data: NoA tracking data
7468 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7469 *
7470 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
7471 */
7472 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
7473 struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7474
7475 /**
7476 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
7477 *
7478 * @data: NoA tracking data
7479 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7480 */
7481 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7482
7483 /**
7484 * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
7485 * @vif: virtual interface
7486 * @peer: the peer's destination address
7487 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
7488 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
7489 * @gfp: allocation flags
7490 *
7491 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
7492 */
7493 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7494 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7495 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7496
7497 /**
7498 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7499 *
7500 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7501 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7502 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7503 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7504 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7505 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7506 *
7507 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7508 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7509 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7510 *
7511 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7512 * @tid: the TID to reserve
7513 *
7514 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7515 */
7516 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7517
7518 /**
7519 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7520 *
7521 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7522 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7523 * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7524 *
7525 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7526 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7527 * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7528 *
7529 * @sta: the station
7530 * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7531 */
7532 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7533
7534 /**
7535 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7536 *
7537 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7538 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7539 * ieee80211_next_txq()
7540 *
7541 * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7542 *
7543 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7544 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7545 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7546 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7547 * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7548 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7549 * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7550 *
7551 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7552 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7553 */
7554 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7555 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7556
7557 /**
7558 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7559 * (in process context)
7560 *
7561 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7562 * (internally disables bottom halves).
7563 *
7564 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7565 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7566 * ieee80211_next_txq()
7567 *
7568 * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7569 */
ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7570 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7571 struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7572 {
7573 struct sk_buff *skb;
7574
7575 local_bh_disable();
7576 skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7577 local_bh_enable();
7578
7579 return skb;
7580 }
7581
7582 /**
7583 * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7584 *
7585 * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7586 * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7587 *
7588 * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7589 * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7590 */
7591 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7592 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7593
7594 /**
7595 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7596 *
7597 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7598 * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7599 *
7600 * Return: the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7601 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7602 * driver has finished scheduling it.
7603 */
7604 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7605
7606 /**
7607 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7608 *
7609 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7610 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7611 *
7612 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7613 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7614 */
7615 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7616
7617 /* (deprecated) */
ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u8 ac)7618 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7619 {
7620 }
7621
7622 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7623 struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7624
7625 /**
7626 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7627 *
7628 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7629 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7630 *
7631 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7632 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7633 *
7634 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7635 * this TXQ internally.
7636 */
7637 static inline void
ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)7638 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7639 {
7640 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7641 }
7642
7643 /**
7644 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7645 *
7646 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7647 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7648 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7649 *
7650 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7651 * internally.
7652 */
7653 static inline void
ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq,bool force)7654 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7655 bool force)
7656 {
7657 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7658 }
7659
7660 /**
7661 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7662 *
7663 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7664 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7665 * fairness accounting without using the scheduling order enforced by
7666 * next_txq().
7667 *
7668 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7669 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7670 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7671 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7672 * again.
7673 *
7674 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7675 * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7676 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7677 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7678 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7679 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7680 *
7681 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7682 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7683 *
7684 * Return: %true if transmission is allowed, %false otherwise
7685 */
7686 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7687 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7688
7689 /**
7690 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7691 *
7692 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7693 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7694 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7695 *
7696 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7697 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7698 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7699 */
7700 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7701 unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7702 unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7703
7704 /**
7705 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7706 *
7707 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7708 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7709 *
7710 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7711 * @inst_id: the local instance id
7712 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7713 * @gfp: allocation flags
7714 */
7715 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7716 u8 inst_id,
7717 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7718 gfp_t gfp);
7719
7720 /**
7721 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7722 *
7723 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7724 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7725 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7726 *
7727 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7728 * @match: match event information
7729 * @gfp: allocation flags
7730 */
7731 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7732 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7733 gfp_t gfp);
7734
7735 /**
7736 * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7737 *
7738 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7739 * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7740 *
7741 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7742 * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7743 * information.
7744 * @len: frame length in bytes
7745 *
7746 * Return: the airtime estimate
7747 */
7748 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7749 struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7750 int len);
7751
7752 /**
7753 * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7754 *
7755 * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7756 * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7757 *
7758 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7759 * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7760 * @len: frame length in bytes
7761 *
7762 * Return: the airtime estimate
7763 */
7764 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7765 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7766 int len);
7767 /**
7768 * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7769 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7770 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7771 *
7772 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7773 *
7774 * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7775 */
7776 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7777 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7778
7779 /**
7780 * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7781 * probe response template.
7782 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7783 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7784 *
7785 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7786 *
7787 * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7788 */
7789 struct sk_buff *
7790 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7791 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7792
7793 /**
7794 * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7795 * collision.
7796 * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
7797 *
7798 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7799 * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7800 * aware of.
7801 */
7802 void
7803 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7804 u64 color_bitmap, u8 link_id);
7805
7806 /**
7807 * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7808 *
7809 * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7810 * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7811 *
7812 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7813 *
7814 * Return: %true if @skb is a data frame, %false otherwise
7815 */
ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff * skb)7816 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7817 {
7818 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7819 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7820
7821 return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7822 ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7823 }
7824
7825 /**
7826 * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7827 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7828 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7829 *
7830 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; may sleep; calls
7831 * back into the driver.
7832 *
7833 * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7834 * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7835 * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7836 *
7837 * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7838 * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7839 * a sequence of calls like
7840 *
7841 * - change_vif_links(0x11)
7842 * - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7843 * - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7844 * - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7845 * (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7846 * - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7847 * - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7848 * - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7849 * - change_vif_links(0x10)
7850 *
7851 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7852 */
7853 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7854
7855 /**
7856 * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7857 * @vif: interface to set active links on
7858 * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7859 *
7860 * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7861 * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7862 * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7863 * completed after it returns.
7864 */
7865 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7866 u16 active_links);
7867
7868 /**
7869 * ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm - tear down a negotiated TTLM request
7870 * @vif: the interface on which the tear down request should be sent.
7871 *
7872 * This function can be used to tear down a previously accepted negotiated
7873 * TTLM request.
7874 */
7875 void ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7876
7877 /**
7878 * ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw - convert channel width to STA RX bandwidth
7879 * @width: the channel width value to convert
7880 * Return: the STA RX bandwidth value for the channel width
7881 */
7882 static inline enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth
ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw(enum nl80211_chan_width width)7883 ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw(enum nl80211_chan_width width)
7884 {
7885 switch (width) {
7886 default:
7887 WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
7888 fallthrough;
7889 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
7890 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
7891 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20;
7892 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
7893 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40;
7894 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80:
7895 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80;
7896 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160:
7897 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80:
7898 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160;
7899 case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320:
7900 return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320;
7901 }
7902 }
7903
7904 /**
7905 * ieee80211_prepare_rx_omi_bw - prepare for sending BW RX OMI
7906 * @link_sta: the link STA the OMI is going to be sent to
7907 * @bw: the bandwidth requested
7908 *
7909 * When the driver decides to do RX OMI to change bandwidth with a STA
7910 * it calls this function to prepare, then sends the OMI, and finally
7911 * calls ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw().
7912 *
7913 * Note that the (link) STA rate control is updated accordingly as well,
7914 * but the chanctx might not be updated if there are other users.
7915 * If the intention is to reduce the listen bandwidth, the driver must
7916 * ensure there are no TDLS stations nor other uses of the chanctx.
7917 *
7918 * Also note that in order to sequence correctly, narrowing bandwidth
7919 * will only happen in ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw(), whereas widening
7920 * again (e.g. going back to normal) will happen here.
7921 *
7922 * Note that we treat this symmetrically, so if the driver calls this
7923 * and tells the peer to only send with a lower bandwidth, we assume
7924 * that the driver also wants to only send at that lower bandwidth, to
7925 * allow narrowing of the chanctx request for this station/interface.
7926 *
7927 * Finally, the driver must ensure that if the function returned %true,
7928 * ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw() is also called, even for example in
7929 * case of HW restart.
7930 *
7931 * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held, and will call back
7932 * into the driver, so ensure no driver locks are held.
7933 *
7934 * Return: %true if changes are going to be made, %false otherwise
7935 */
7936 bool ieee80211_prepare_rx_omi_bw(struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
7937 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bw);
7938
7939 /**
7940 * ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw - finalize BW RX OMI update
7941 * @link_sta: the link STA the OMI was sent to
7942 *
7943 * See ieee80211_client_prepare_rx_omi_bw(). Context is the same here
7944 * as well.
7945 */
7946 void ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw(struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta);
7947
7948 /* for older drivers - let's not document these ... */
7949 int ieee80211_emulate_add_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7950 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7951 void ieee80211_emulate_remove_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7952 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
7953 void ieee80211_emulate_change_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7954 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
7955 u32 changed);
7956 int ieee80211_emulate_switch_vif_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7957 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
7958 int n_vifs,
7959 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
7960
7961 /**
7962 * ieee80211_vif_nan_started - Return whether a NAN vif is started
7963 * @vif: the vif
7964 * Return: %true iff the vif is a NAN interface and NAN is started
7965 */
7966 bool ieee80211_vif_nan_started(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7967 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
7968